US20130230898A1 - Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation - Google Patents

Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20130230898A1
US20130230898A1 US13/770,275 US201313770275A US2013230898A1 US 20130230898 A1 US20130230898 A1 US 20130230898A1 US 201313770275 A US201313770275 A US 201313770275A US 2013230898 A1 US2013230898 A1 US 2013230898A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
group
reaction
substituted
derivative
hes
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US13/770,275
Inventor
Frank Hacket
Thomas Hey
Franziska Hauschild
Helmut Knoller
Martin Schimmel
Klaus Sommermeyer
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH
Original Assignee
Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH filed Critical Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH
Priority to US13/770,275 priority Critical patent/US20130230898A1/en
Assigned to FRESENIUS KABI DEUTSCHLAND GMBH reassignment FRESENIUS KABI DEUTSCHLAND GMBH ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: HAUSCHILD, FRANZISKA, SOMMERMEYER, KLAUS, HACKET, FRANK, HEY, THOMAS, KNOLLER, HELMUT, SCHIMMEL, MARTIN
Publication of US20130230898A1 publication Critical patent/US20130230898A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08BPOLYSACCHARIDES; DERIVATIVES THEREOF
    • C08B31/00Preparation of derivatives of starch
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08BPOLYSACCHARIDES; DERIVATIVES THEREOF
    • C08B31/00Preparation of derivatives of starch
    • C08B31/08Ethers
    • C08B31/12Ethers having alkyl or cycloalkyl radicals substituted by heteroatoms, e.g. hydroxyalkyl or carboxyalkyl starch
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C08ORGANIC MACROMOLECULAR COMPOUNDS; THEIR PREPARATION OR CHEMICAL WORKING-UP; COMPOSITIONS BASED THEREON
    • C08BPOLYSACCHARIDES; DERIVATIVES THEREOF
    • C08B31/00Preparation of derivatives of starch
    • C08B31/08Ethers
    • C08B31/12Ethers having alkyl or cycloalkyl radicals substituted by heteroatoms, e.g. hydroxyalkyl or carboxyalkyl starch
    • C08B31/125Ethers having alkyl or cycloalkyl radicals substituted by heteroatoms, e.g. hydroxyalkyl or carboxyalkyl starch having a substituent containing at least one nitrogen atom, e.g. cationic starch
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/30Macromolecular organic or inorganic compounds, e.g. inorganic polyphosphates
    • A61K47/36Polysaccharides; Derivatives thereof, e.g. gums, starch, alginate, dextrin, hyaluronic acid, chitosan, inulin, agar or pectin
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/56Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule
    • A61K47/61Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule the organic macromolecular compound being a polysaccharide or a derivative thereof
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P19/00Drugs for skeletal disorders
    • A61P19/08Drugs for skeletal disorders for bone diseases, e.g. rachitism, Paget's disease
    • A61P19/10Drugs for skeletal disorders for bone diseases, e.g. rachitism, Paget's disease for osteoporosis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/02Antineoplastic agents specific for leukemia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/04Antihaemorrhagics; Procoagulants; Haemostatic agents; Antifibrinolytic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P7/00Drugs for disorders of the blood or the extracellular fluid
    • A61P7/06Antianaemics

Definitions

  • the invention relates to a method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative which comprises reacting hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) via the optionally oxidised reducing end of the HAS with the amino group M of a crosslinking compound which, apart from the amino group, comprises a specifically protected carbonyl group, namely an acetal group or a ketal group.
  • the method may further comprise a reaction of the HAS derivative thus obtained with the amino group of a biologically active compound via alkylation, preferably via reductive amination.
  • the invention relates to the HAS derivatives obtainable or obtained by the inventive process and to specific HAS derivatives as such.
  • the invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising the HAS derivatives containing the biologically active compound, these HAS derivates as therapeutic or prophylactic agent and the use of specific HAS derivatives for the preparation of medicaments.
  • HES Hydroxyalkyl starch
  • HES hydroxyethyl starch
  • HES hydroxyethyl starch
  • HES exhibits advantageous biological properties and is used as a blood volume replacement agent and in hemodilution therapy in the clinics (Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Whypharmazie, 8(8), 271-278; Weidler et al., 1991, Arzneistoff-aba/Drug Res., 41, 494-498).
  • DE 26 16 086 discloses the conjugation of hemoglobin to hydroxyethyl starch wherein, in a first step, a cross-linking agent, e.g. bromocyane, is bound to hydroxyethyl starch and subsequently hemoglobin is linked to the intermediate product.
  • a cross-linking agent e.g. bromocyane
  • HES HES-like styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styrene-styl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-linked glycoprotein
  • red blood cells in the circulation erythropoietin
  • WO 94/28024 discloses that physiologically active polypeptides modified with polyethylene glycol (PEG) exhibit reduced immunogenicity and antigenicity and circulate in the bloodstream considerably longer than unconjugated proteins, i.e. have a longer clearance rate.
  • PEG-drug conjugates exhibit several disadvantages, e.g. they do not exhibit a natural structure which can be recognized by elements of in vivo degradation pathways. Therefore, apart from PEG-conjugates, other conjugates and protein polymerates have been produced.
  • WO 02/080979 discloses compounds comprising a conjugate of an active agent and a hydroxyalkyl starch wherein active agent and hydroxyalkyl starch are either linked directly or via a linker compound.
  • the reaction of active agent and hydroxyalkyl starch is carried out in an aqueous medium which comprises at least 10 wt.-% of water.
  • No examples are given which are directed to a hydroxyalkyl starch linked to crosslinking compound via an amino group of said crosslinking compound wherein the crosslinking compound further contains a protected carbonyl group.
  • no examples are given showing a HAS derivative which is obtained by reacting said HAS derivative via said carbonyl group with an amino group of a biologically active agent.
  • WO 03/074087 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch protein conjugates in which the bonding between a hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and a protein is covalent and is the result of a coupling of a terminal aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or a functional group which resulted from the reaction of said aldehyde group with a functional group of a protein.
  • WO 03/074088 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch conjugates with a low molecular weight compound in which the bonding between the hydroxyalkyl starch and the low molecular weight compound is covalent and is the result of a coupling of a terminal aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or a functional group which resulted from the reaction of said aldehyde group with a functional group of a protein.
  • WO 2005/014024 discloses polymers functionalized by an aminooxy group or a derivative thereof, conjugates, wherein the functionalized polymers are covalently coupled with a protein by an oxime linking group, a process for preparing the functionalized polymers, a process for preparing the conjugates, functionalized polymers as obtainable by the process of the present invention, conjugates as obtainable by the process, and pharmaceutical compositions comprising at least one conjugate and the use of said conjugates and compositions for the prophylaxis or therapy of the human or animal body.
  • WO 2005/092390 discloses conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein wherein these conjugates are formed by a covalent linkage between the hydroxyalkyl starch or a derivative of the hydroxyalkyl starch and the protein and a method of producing these conjugates and the use of these conjugates.
  • WO 2004/024777 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivates, particularly hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process in which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a linker compound. According to an especially preferred embodiment, WO 2004/024777 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process according to which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a linker compound and the resulting reaction product is reacted with a polypeptide, preferably with a glycoprotein and especially preferably with erythropoietin, via at least one other reactive group of the linker compound.
  • a hydroxyalkyl starch which is especially preferred is hydroxyethyl starch.
  • the hydroxyalkyl starch and preferably the hydroxylethyl starch is reacted with the linker compound at its reducing end which is not oxidised prior to the reaction.
  • WO 2004/024776 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivates, particularly hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process in which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a crosslinking compound or with two crosslinking compounds wherein the resulting hydroxyalkyl starch derivative has at least one functional group X which is capable of being reacted with a functional group Y of a further compound and wherein this group Y of the further compound is an aldehyde group, a keto group, a hemiacetal group, an acetal group, or a thio group.
  • WO 2004/024776 relates to hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process according to which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a crosslinking compound, the resulting reaction product optionally being further reacted with a second crosslinking compound, wherein the resulting hydroxyalkyl starch derivative has at least one functional group X which is capable of being reacted with a functional group Y of a further compound and wherein this group Y is an aldehyde group, a keto group, a hemiacetal group, an acetal group, or a thio group, and the resulting reaction product is reacted with a polypeptide, preferably with a polypeptide such as AT III, IFN-beta or erythropoietin and especially preferably with erythropoietin, which comprises at least one of these functional groups Y.
  • a polypeptide such as AT III, IFN-beta or
  • a hydroxyalkyl starch which is especially preferred is hydroxyethyl starch.
  • the hydroxyalkyl starch and preferably the hydroxyethyl starch is reacted with the linker compound at its reducing end which is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction.
  • WO 2005/092928 discloses conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch, preferably hydroxyethyl starch, and a protein, wherein these conjugates are formed by a reductive amination reaction between at least one aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or of a derivative of the hydroxyalkyl starch, and at least one amino group of the protein, so that the hydroxyalkyl starch or the derivative thereof is covalently linked to the protein via an azomethine linkage or an aminomethylene linkage.
  • WO 2005/092928 also relates to a method of producing these conjugates and specific uses of the conjugates.
  • US 2006/0194940 A1 discloses water-soluble polymer alkanals. Among others, protected aldehyde reagents are disclosed which are reacted with a polymer. While poly(saccharides) are generically mentioned, especially preferred polymers are polyethylene glycols. Starches or, in particular, modified starches such as hydroxyalkyl starches are not disclosed in US 2006/0194940 A1. Consequently, US 2006/0194940 A1 contains no disclosures concerning specific ways of coupling a given linker compound to hydroxyalkyl starch. The same applies to U.S. Pat. No. 7,157,546 B2, EP 1 591 467 A1 and WO 2004/022630 A2.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2 discloses an aminoacetal crosslinking compound in unprotected and protected form. No disclosure is contained in this document relating to a possible coupling of this crosslinking compound with polymers other than polyethylene glycols. In particular, starches, let alone modified starches such as hydroxyalkyl starches are not disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2. Consequently, U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2 contains no disclosures concerning specific ways of coupling a given linker compound to hydroxyalkyl starch. The same applies to U.S. Pat. No. 6,956,135 B2 and WO 03/049699 A2.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,990,237 discloses structures containing a protected aldehyde group. Compounds comprising these structures are preferably coupled to polyethylene glycol, and coupling is carried out via a halide as functional group comprised in the protected aldehyde group containing compounds, which halide group reacts with a hydroxy group of the polyethylene glycol.
  • HAS derivatives such as HAS derivatives obtained or obtainable by reacting HAS with specifically functionalized crosslinking compounds.
  • HAS derivatives obtained or obtainable by reacting the HAS derivatives—obtained or obtainable by reacting HAS with specifically functionalized crosslinking compounds—with a suitable functional group of biologically active compound.
  • a crosslinking compound which, on the one hand, can selectively be coupled to the optionally oxidized reducing end of a hydroxyalkyl starch via an amino group and, on the other hand, has—as a second functional group—a fully protected carbonyl group, namely an acetal group or a ketal group.
  • a crosslinking compound is employed having a free aldehyde or keto group or, e.g., a hemiacetal group as functional group
  • employing such a fully protected group drastically minimises the risk that, during reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound, undesired oligomerisation or polymerisation between the crosslinking compound molecules takes places.
  • deprotection of the acetal or ketal group comprised in the resulting HAS derivative is possible without at least partially destroying the specific chemical structure of the hydroxyalkyl starch, in particular the hydroxyethyl starch, being characterised by numerous functional groups such as acetal groups and ether groups.
  • the present invention allows for an extremely effective method of preparing a first HAS derivative by minimising the risk of oliogomerisation or polymerisation between the individual crosslinking compound molecules, combined with the possibility of deprotecting the functional groups of the resulting HAS derivatives without at least partial destruction of the HAS structure, in order to provide a HAS derivative allowing for an effective coupling with a biologically active compound.
  • the present invention relates to a method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative, comprising
  • the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative obtainable or obtained by this method.
  • HAS hydroxyalkyl starch
  • the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative of formula (III)
  • A is an acetal or ketal group
  • L is a spacer bridging X and A
  • X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of an amino group M of a crosslinking compound of formula (II)
  • HAS hydroxyalkyl starch
  • HAS via carbon atom C* of the HAS, wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M, wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch refers to a starch derivative which has been substituted by at least one hydroxyalkyl group.
  • a preferred hydroxyalkyl starch of the present invention has a constitution according to formula (I′)
  • HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen, a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group or the group
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 , and R 4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, and alkyl group, preferably hydrogen and methyl group, m is 2 to 4, wherein the residues R 1 and R 2 may be the same or different in the m groups CR 1 R 2 ; n is 0 to 20, preferably 0 to 4; o is 2 to 20, preferably 2 to 4, wherein the residues R 3 and R 4 may be the same or different in the o groups CR 3 R 4 .
  • R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently a group —(CH 2 CH 2 O) n —H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6, and in particular, R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or 2-hydroxyethyl.
  • HAS′ refers to the HAS molecule without the terminal saccharide unit at the reducing end of the HAS molecule. This is meant by the term “remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule” as used in the context of the present invention.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch as used in the present invention is not limited to compounds where the terminal carbohydrate moiety comprises hydroxyalkyl groups R 1 , R 2 and/or R 3 as depicted, for the sake of brevity, in formulas (I) and (I′), but also refers to compounds in which at least one hydroxy group which is present anywhere, either in the terminal carbohydrate moiety and/or in the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule, HAS′, is substituted by a hydroxyalkyl group R 1 , R 2 and/or R 3 .
  • Hydroxyalkyl starch comprising two or more different hydroxyalkyl groups is also possible.
  • the at least one hydroxyalkyl group comprised in HAS may contain one or more, in particular two or more hydroxy groups. According to a preferred embodiment, the at least one hydroxyalkyl group comprised in HAS contains one hydroxy group.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch also includes derivatives wherein the alkyl group is mono- or polysubstituted. In this context, it is preferred that the alkyl group is substituted with a halogen, especially fluorine, or with an aryl group. Furthermore, the hydroxy group of a hydroxyalkyl group may be esterified or etherified.
  • alkyl instead of alkyl, also linear or branched substituted or unsubstituted alkenyl groups may be used.
  • Hydroxyalkyl starch is an ether derivative of starch.
  • ether derivatives also other starch derivatives can be used in the context of the present invention.
  • derivatives are useful which comprise esterified hydroxy groups. These derivatives may be e.g. derivatives of unsubstituted mono- or dicarboxylic acids with 2-12 carbon atoms or of substituted derivatives thereof.
  • derivatives of unsubstituted monocarboxylic acids with 2-6 carbon atoms especially derivatives of acetic acid.
  • acetyl starch, butyryl starch and propionyl starch are preferred.
  • derivatives of dicarboxylic acids it is useful that the second carboxy group of the dicarboxylic acid is also esterified. Furthermore, derivatives of monoalkyl esters of dicarboxylic acids are also suitable in the context of the present invention.
  • the substitute groups may be preferably the same as mentioned above for substituted alkyl residues.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch according to above-mentioned formula (I) is employed.
  • the other saccharide ring structures comprised in HAS′ may be the same as or different from the explicitly described saccharide ring, with the difference that they lack a reducing end.
  • R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a hydroxyalkyl group, a hydroxyaralkyl group or a hydroxyalkaryl group having of from 2 to 10 carbon atoms in the respective alkyl residue. Hydrogen and hydroxyalkyl groups having of from 2 to 10 carbon atoms are preferred. More preferably, the hydroxyalkyl group has from 2 to 6 carbon atoms, more preferably from 2 to 4 carbon atoms, and even more preferably from 2 to 3 carbon atoms.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch is hydroxyethyl starch in which R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a group (CH 2 CH 2 O) n —H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • “Hydroxyalkyl starch” therefore preferably comprises hydroxyethyl starch, hydroxypropyl starch and hydroxybutyl starch, wherein hydroxyethyl starch and hydroxypropyl starch are particularly preferred and hydroxyethyl starch is most preferred.
  • the alkyl, aralkyl and/or alkaryl group may be linear or branched and suitably substituted.
  • the present invention also relates to a method and a HAS derivative as described above wherein R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group with from 2 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • R 1 , R 2 and R 3 preferably may be H, hydroxyhexyl, hydroxypentyl, hydroxybutyl, hydroxypropyl such as 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyisopropyl, hydroxyethyl such as 2-hydroxyethyl, hydrogen and the 2-hydroxyethyl group being especially preferred.
  • the present invention also relates to a method and a HAS derivative as described above wherein R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a 2-hydroxyethyl group, an embodiment wherein at least one residue R 1 , R 2 and R 3 being 2-hydroxyethyl being especially preferred.
  • Hydroxyethyl starch is most preferred for all embodiments of the present invention.
  • the present invention relates to the method and a HAS derivative as described above, wherein the polymer is hydroxyethyl starch and the derivative is a hydroxyethyl starch (HES) derivative.
  • HAS hydroxyethyl starch
  • HAS in particular HES, is mainly characterized by the molecular weight distribution, the degree of substitution and the ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution. There are two possibilities of describing the substitution degree:
  • the degree of substitution (DS) of HAS is described relatively to the portion of substituted glucose monomers with respect to all glucose moieties.
  • the substitution pattern of HAS can also be described as the molar substitution (MS), wherein the number of hydroxyethyl groups per glucose moiety is counted.
  • HAS preferably HES
  • MS substitution pattern of HAS, preferably HES
  • MS is determined by Gas Chromatography after total hydrolysis of the HES molecule. MS values of respective HAS, in particular HES starting material are given. It is assumed that the MS value is not affected during the derivatization procedure in steps a) and b) of the process of the invention.
  • HAS and in particular HES solutions are present as polydisperse compositions, wherein each molecule differs from the other with respect to the polymerization degree, the number and pattern of branching sites, and the substitution pattern.
  • HAS and in particular HES is therefore a mixture of compounds with different molecular weight. Consequently, a particular HAS and in particular HES solution is determined by average molecular weight with the help of statistical means.
  • M n is calculated as the arithmetic mean depending on the number of molecules.
  • M w (or MW) the weight average molecular weight, represents a unit which depends on the mass of the HAS, in particular HES.
  • M _ n ⁇ i ⁇ ⁇ n i ⁇ M i ⁇ i ⁇ ⁇ n i
  • n i is the number of molecules of species i of molar mass M i .
  • M n indicates that the value is an average, but the line is normally omitted by convention.
  • M w is the weight average molecular weight, defined by equation 2:
  • M _ w ⁇ i ⁇ ⁇ n i ⁇ M i 2 ⁇ i ⁇ ⁇ n i ⁇ M i
  • n i is the number of molecules of species i of molar mass M i
  • M w indicates that the value is an average, but the line is normally omitted by convention.
  • the hydroxyalkyl starch, in particular the hydroxyethyl starch, used in the invention has a mean molecular weight (weight mean) of from 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa.
  • Hydroxyethyl starch can further exhibit a preferred molar substitution of from 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.1 to 2, more preferred 0.1 to 0.9 or 0.4 to 2, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, and a preferred ratio between C 2 :C 6 substitution in the range of from 2 to 20 with respect to the hydroxyethyl groups.
  • mean molecular weight as used in the context of the present invention relates to the weight as determined according to the LALLS-(low angle laser light scattering)-GPC method as described in Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Whypharmazie, 8(8), 271-278; and Weidler et al., 1991, Arzneim.-Forschung/Drug Res., 41, 494-498.
  • mean molecular weights of 10 kDa and smaller additionally, the calibration was carried out with a standard which had previously been qualified by LALLS-GPC.
  • the mean molecular weight of hydroxyethyl starch employed is from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa.
  • the molar substitution of HAS and in particular HES is preferably from about 0.1 to about 3, preferably about 0.4 to about 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3.
  • HES having a mean molecular weight of about 5 to 300 kDa, preferably 50 to 150 kDa is a HES with a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3.
  • substitution is preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the methods of the present invention can also be carried out, and the derivatives of the present invention can also be prepared using other starches than hydroxyalkyl starches, in particular hydroxyethyl starch as described above, with the proviso that these starches also contain a reducing end being present in the hemiacetal form, optionally in equilibrium with the (free) aldehyde from, which reducing end may suitably be oxidised to give the respective oxidised form.
  • a highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be employed, i.e.
  • a starch which has a significantly higher degree of branching than amylopectin and has the degree of alpha-1,6 branching of glycogen, or even exceeds this, and, if substituted, has a molar substitution MS of only up to 0.3, preferably of from 0.05 to 0.3.
  • MS molar substitution
  • the term MS (molar substitution) as used in the context of this highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product means the average number of hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups per anhydroglucose unit.
  • the MS is normally measured by determining the content of hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups in a sample and computational allocation to the anhydroglucose units present therein.
  • the MS can also be determined by gas chromatography.
  • the degree of branching can be determined by a gas chromatographic methylation analysis as mol-% of the alpha-1,4,6-glycosidically linked anhydroglucoses in the polymer.
  • the degree of branching is in every case an average because the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product of the invention is a polydisperse compound.
  • the glucose units in said highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product are linked via alpha-1,4- and alpha-1,6-linkages.
  • the degree of branching means the proportion of alpha-1,4,6-linked glucose units in mol % of the totality of all anhydroglucoses.
  • the C 2 /C 6 ratio expresses the ratio or substitution at C-2 to that at C-6.
  • the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product has a preferred degree of branching of from 6% to 50%, achievable by a transglucosidation step with the aid of branching enzymes. Even more preferably, the degree of branching is in the range of from 10 to 45, more preferably from 20 to 40 such as 20, 25, 30, 35, or 40. Also preferred are ranges of from more than 20 to 40, preferably from more than 20 to 30 such as from 21 to 40, preferably from 21 to 30.
  • the starting material which can be used for this purpose is in principle any starch, but preferably waxy starches with a high proportion of amylopectin or the amylopectin fraction itself.
  • Preferred highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products have a degree of branching of more than 10% and up to 20% and in particular from 11 to 18%.
  • a higher degree of branching means a greater solubility of the starch products of the invention and a greater bioavailability of these dissolved starch products in the body.
  • Particular preference is given to unmodified starch products with a degree of branching of more than 10%, in particular from 11% to 18%.
  • the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be prepared by targeted enzymatic assembly using so-called branching or transfer enzymes, where appropriate followed by partial derivatisation of free hydroxyl groups with hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups. Instead of this it is possible to convert a hydroxyethylated or hydroxypropylated starch by enzymatic assembly using so-called branching or transfer enzymes into a highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product.
  • branching or transfer enzymes Obtaining branched starch products enzymatically from wheat starch with a degree of branching of up to 10% is known per se and described for example in WO 00/66633 A.
  • Suitable branching or transfer enzymes and the obtaining thereof are disclosed in WO 00/18893 A, U.S. Pat. No. 4,454,161, EP 0 418 945 A, JP 2001294601 A or US 2002/065410 A. This latter publication describes unmodified starch products with degrees of branching of more than 4% and up to 10% or higher.
  • the enzymatic transglycosilation can be carried out in a manner known per se, for example by incubating waxy corn starch, potato starch obtained from potatoes having a high amylopectin content, or starch obtained from rice, from manioc, from wheat, from wheat having a high amylopectin content, from corn, from corn having a high amolypectin content, or from corn having a high amylose content, with the appropriate enzymes under mild conditions at pH values between 6 and 8 and temperatures between 25 and 40° C. in aqueous solution.
  • the molecular weight M w means, as used in the context of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products, the weight average molecular weight. This can be determined in a manner known per se by various methods, i.e. by gel permeation chromatography (GPC) or high pressure liquid chromatography (HPLC) in conjunction with light scattering and RI detection.
  • GPC gel permeation chromatography
  • HPLC high pressure liquid chromatography
  • the C 2 /C 6 ratio preferred for substituted starches is in the range from 5 to 9.
  • the high degree of branching of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products increases the solubility in water thereof to such an extent that hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl substitution can be wholly or substantially dispensed with in order to keep the starch product in solution.
  • the average molecular weight of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be increased in a suitable manner via the permeability limit of the peritoneum.
  • the characteristic variable which can be used in this case is also the GPC value of the so-called bottom fraction BF90% (molecular weight at 90% of the peak area as a measure of the proportion of smaller molecule fractions).
  • a greater ultrafiltration (UF) efficiency can be achieved by appropriate raising of the molecular weight with, at the same time, a drastically reduced absorption across the peritoneal membrane.
  • high molecular weight residual fragments which are produced by degradation by endogenous amylase, which can no longer be further degraded by amylase, and which are stored in organs or tissues, no longer occur or now occur to only a slight extent.
  • hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a crosslinking compound M-L-A wherein M is an amino group and A is an acetal group or a ketal group, group M and group L being separated by a suitable spacer.
  • acetal group also comprises sulphur acetals and nitrogen acetals
  • ketal group also comprises sulphur ketals and nitrogen ketals. Additionally, as far as the term “acetal group” is concerned, hemiacetals are explicitly excluded, and as far as the term “ketal group” is concerned, hemiketals are explicitly excluded.
  • group A of the crosslinking compound M-L-A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
  • Z 1 and Z 2 are each independently O or S or NR x , preferably O, wherein R x , is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl such as n-propyl or i-propyl, or C(O)—R y wherein R y is preferably selected from the group consisting of C 1 -C 6 alkyl and C 6 -C 14 aryl, even more preferably selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl; R x preferably being H; A 1 and A 2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitro
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are —(CH 2 ) 2 — or —(CH 2 ) 3 — or —(CH 2 CH(CH 3 ))—, and wherein A 3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L.
  • At least one of Z 1 and Z 2 is O, more preferably both Z 1 and Z 2 are O.
  • a 3 is preferably H.
  • A is a ketal group, it is preferred that A 3 is methyl. Therefore, conceivable ketal groups A according to the present invention are, among others,
  • crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are, e.g., forming a ring with either the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, conceivable crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are, e.g.,
  • An especially preferred crosslinking compound according to the present invention is
  • the amino group M is a secondary amine
  • both Z 1 and Z 2 are O
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are —(CH 2 ) 2 —.
  • a 1 and A 2 are each methyl or ethyl, even more preferably ethyl. Therefore, a particularly preferred acetal group A according to the present invention is —CH(OCH 3 ) 2 or —CH(OC 2 H 5 ) 2 , in particular —CH(OC 2 H 5 ) 2 .
  • a 1 and A 2 are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are preferably —(CH 2 ) 2 —.
  • particularly preferred acetal groups A according to the present invention are
  • the amino group M can be reacted with either the oxidised or non-oxidised reducing end, i.e. via carbon atom C* of the reducing terminal saccharide unit of HAS, preferably HES, in either the non-oxidised state, i.e. as hemiacetal or as free aldehyde group, or in the oxidised state, i.e. as lactone or as free carboxy group.
  • amino group as used in this context of the present application also comprises suitable salts of the amino group, such as, e.g., protonated amino groups, with a pharmaceutically acceptable anion, such as, e.g., chloride, hydrogen sulfate, sulfate, carbonate, hydrogen carbonate, citrate, phosphate, or hydrogen phosphate.
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable anion such as, e.g., chloride, hydrogen sulfate, sulfate, carbonate, hydrogen carbonate, citrate, phosphate, or hydrogen phosphate.
  • the amino group of the crosslinking compound M-L-A according to the present invention is a group according to formula (IIc)
  • Y is either absent or is a chemical moiety selected from the group consisting of
  • G is O or S or NH, and, if present twice, each G is independently O or S or NH, G preferably being O, and wherein R′ is H or a hydroxy group or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, and substituted alkylaryl.
  • alkyl relates to non-branched alkyl residues, branched alkyl residues, and cycloalkyl residues.
  • each of these organic residues has from 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • substituents halogens such as F, Cl or Br may be mentioned.
  • the organic residues are non-substituted hydrocarbons.
  • R′ is a hydroxy group
  • the preferred amino group of the present invention is HO—NH—, i.e. Y is absent.
  • R′ is an organic residue
  • R′ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl, the alkyl residue being especially preferred.
  • the optionally substituted alkyl residue has from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4 such as 1, 2, 3, or 4 carbon atoms.
  • preferred organic residues according to the present invention are methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, or t-butyl.
  • the organic residue R′ is methyl or ethyl, in particular methyl.
  • preferred amino groups according to the present invention are, e.g., H 3 C—CH 2 —NH—, H 3 C—NH—, H 5 C 6 —NH—, H 3 C—CH 2 —NH—O—, H 3 C—NH—O—, H 5 C 6 —NH—O—, with H 3 C—NH—, H 5 C 6 —NH—, and H 3 C—NH—O— being particularly preferred.
  • R′ is not a separate residue but forms a ring structure with a suitable atom comprised in L or with residue A 3 of group A of the crosslinking compound.
  • These structures are also comprised in above-mentioned definition of the term “alkyl” with respect to R′.
  • R′ can form a ring structure with residue A 3 of group A of the crosslinking compound, A being a ketal group.
  • Conceivable crosslinking compounds are, e.g.,
  • the amino group M is a secondary amine
  • both Z 1 and Z 2 are O
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are —(CH 2 ) 2 —.
  • R′ is H.
  • preferred amino groups M of the present are
  • G is O or S, and, if present twice, independently O or S, O being preferred.
  • Especially preferred amino groups M of the present invention are H 2 N—, H 2 N—O—, and H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—.
  • the present invention also relates to the method and the derivative mentioned above, wherein the amino group M is H 2 N—, H 2 N—O—, H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, H 3 C—NH— or H 3 C—NH—O—, preferably H 2 N—, H 2 N—O—, or H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—.
  • spacer as used in this context of the present application relates to any suitable chemical moiety bridging M and A.
  • L bridging M and A is a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • L 1 and L 2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R′′ wherein R′′ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl.
  • alkyl relates to non-branched alkyl residues, branched alkyl residues, and cycloalkyl residues.
  • halogens such as F, Cl or Br may be mentioned.
  • L 1 and L 2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably, L 1 and L 2 are independently from each other H or alkyl; even more preferably, both L 1 and L 2 are H.
  • each of L 1 and L 2 may independently contain 1 to 20, preferably 1 to 10, more preferably 1 to 8, more preferably 1 to 6, more preferably 1 to 4 carbon atoms.
  • residues L 1 and L 2 such as optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, tert-butyl residues.
  • L 1 may be H and L 2 may be an organic residue as defined above.
  • n is preferably from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • the groups (CL 1 L 2 ) may be the same or different from each other. According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, groups (CL 1 L 2 ) directly linked to each other have the same constitution.
  • the spacer L consists of a structural unit according to formula (IId) wherein L 1 and L 2 are as defined above. More preferably, integer n is from 1 to 20, more preferably from 1 to 10 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10. Even more preferably, each of the groups (CL 1 L 2 ) is (CH 2 ) such that spacer L bridging M and A has the structure
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20, more preferably from 1 to 10 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10. Even more preferably, n is in the range of from 1 to 6, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 4, such as 1, 2, 3, or 4, and in particular 2.
  • spacer L is —CH 2 —CH 2 —.
  • spacer L of the crosslinking compound comprises at least one structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • n, L 1 and L 2 are as defined above, preferably
  • L further comprises at least one chemical moiety different from —(CL 1 L 2 )—.
  • the spacer L consists of a structural unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - and a further chemical moiety T which separates —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - from group M or A.
  • the spacer L consists of a structural unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - and two further chemical moieties T 1 and T 2 wherein T 1 separates —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - from group M and T 2 separates —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - from group A.
  • the crosslinking compound has one of the following structures:
  • T, T 1 and/or T 2 may comprise optionally substituted aryl residues, suitable heteroatoms, suitable functional groups, or the like.
  • functional groups are concerned, embodiments may be mentioned according to which these functional groups result from the preparation of the crosslinking compound wherein at least a first compound and at least a second compound are reacted with each other to give a compound M-L-A.
  • a first compound M-L′-W 1 and a second compound W 2 -L′′-A may be reacted to give crosslinking compound M-L-A wherein -L- is -L′-F-L′′- and F represents the functional group resulting from the reaction of functional group W 1 with functional group W 2 , and wherein at least one of L′ and L′′ comprises the structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -.
  • Such functional groups W 1 and W 2 may be suitably chosen.
  • one of groups W 1 and W 2 i.e.
  • W 1 or W 2 may be chosen from the group consisting of the functional groups according to the following list while the other group, W 2 or W 1 , is suitable selected and capable of forming a chemical linkage with W 1 or W 2 , wherein W 2 or W 1 is also preferably selected from the above-mentioned group:
  • W 1 or W 2 may be a carboxy group or an activated ester
  • W 2 or W 1 may be an amino group or a hydroxy group such that F representing the functional group resulting from the reaction of functional group W 1 with functional group W 2 , is an amid or an ester.
  • crosslinking compounds having a spacer L comprising, apart from structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -, a functional group, may have a constitution such as
  • L′ and L′′ may or may not comprise a structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -.
  • crosslinking compounds are preferred having constitutions
  • spacers are preferred wherein L′ and L′′, if present, contain the structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -.
  • n is in the range of from 1 to 4, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 3, such as 1, 2, or 3. If a given spacer contains, for example, two structure units —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -, index n of each structure unit may be the same or different.
  • crosslinking compounds are preferred having the following constitutions:
  • each n is, independently from each other, preferably in the range of from 1 to 4, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 3, such as 1, 2, or 3. Accordingly, preferred spacers L have the constitution
  • crosslinking compounds containing —(C ⁇ O)—NH— are particularly preferred crosslinking compounds containing —(C ⁇ O)—NH—.
  • L 1 and L 2 are both H.
  • preferred crosslinking compounds of the present invention are:
  • crosslinking compound conceivable in the context of the present invention may be
  • spacer L may comprise more than one structure units —(CL 1 L 2 ) n - wherein these structure units may be same or different, i.e. the structure may differ in n and/or L 1 and/or L 2 , wherein at least two such structure units may be separated by a heteroatom such as O or S.
  • the spacer L comprises at least one structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n1 -O—(CL 1 L 2 ) n2 -, preferably —(CH 2 ) n1 —O—(CH 2 ) n2 wherein n1 is equal to or different from n2, and wherein the spacer L is linked via —(CL 1 L 2 ) n1 - to the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, i.e. the crosslinking compound comprising the following sub-structure
  • spacer structures such as
  • n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • m is 1, 2, or 3, more preferably 2 or 3.
  • n1 is from 2 to 4, and more preferably 2.
  • n2 is from 1 to 4, more preferably 1 or 2. Therefore, preferred structures are, by way of example,
  • crosslinking compound preferably used in the context of the present invention is
  • group M and group A may be separated by 2 suitable chemical moieties, at least one thereof comprising —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -, such that the N atom of group M and the C atom of ketal group A are forming a ring.
  • suitable chemical moieties at least one thereof comprising —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -, such that the N atom of group M and the C atom of ketal group A are forming a ring.
  • Especially preferred crosslinking compounds of the present invention are compounds having, as group M, the group H 2 N— or the group H 2 N—O— or the group H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, especially preferably the group H 2 N—, and, as group A, an acetal group, preferably an acetal group having the structure
  • the spacer L consists of structure unit —(CL 1 L 2 ) n -, with L 1 and L 2 preferably being H, and integer n even more preferably being from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are, by way of example,
  • the cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). More preferably, the cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). In particular, cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • crosslinking compound M-L-A is 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane
  • the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative obtainable or obtained by the method as described above.
  • HAS hydroxyalkyl starch
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative of formula (III)
  • A is an acetal or ketal group
  • L is a spacer bridging X and A
  • X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of an amino group M of a crosslinking compound of formula (II)
  • HAS hydroxyalkyl starch
  • HAS via carbon atom C* of the HAS, wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M, wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
  • HAS preferably HES, L, A, R 1 , R 2 , and R 3 are concerned, specific reference is made to the embodiments as described hereinabove.
  • the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein R 1 , R 2 and R 3 are independently a group —(CH 2 CH 2 O) n —H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein the hydroxyalkyl starch is hydroxyethyl starch (HES).
  • HAS hydroxyethyl starch
  • the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
  • Z 1 and Z 2 are each independently O or S or NR x , preferably O, wherein R x is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl, preferably H;
  • a 1 and A 2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzyl, methoxybenzyl, ethoxybenzyl, or are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are —(CH 2 ) 2 — or —(CH 2 ) 3 — or —(CH 2 CH(CH 3 ))—, and wherein A 3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, A 3 preferably being H.
  • group X of the HAS derivative according to the invention depends on the respective chemical nature of group M, on the oxidation state of the carbon atom C* of the reducing end of HAS, and on the reaction conditions such as solvent, temperature and so forth employed for the reaction. According to embodiments of the present invention wherein the carbon atom C* is employed in oxidised and non-oxidised state, specific and preferred examples are discussed in detail hereinunder.
  • the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein X is selected from the group consisting of —CH ⁇ N—, —CH 2 —NH—, —CH ⁇ N—O—, —CH 2 —NH—O—, —C( ⁇ O)—NH—, —C( ⁇ O)—NH—NH—, —CH ⁇ N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, —CH 2 —NH—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, preferably consisting of —CH 2 —NH—, —CH ⁇ N—, —CH ⁇ N—O—, —CH 2 —NH—O—, —CH ⁇ N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, and —CH 2 —NH—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, more preferably consisting of —CH 2 —NH—, —CH ⁇ N—, —CH ⁇ N—O—, and —CH 2 —NH—O—.
  • the terminal saccharide unit of the HAS as present in the HAS derivative is present in a ring structure which may be in equilibrium with the open structure according to formula (III) above, the ring structure and the open structure having a certain equilibrium distribution.
  • formula (III) as given above comprises the open structure as well as the ring structure, and formula (III) does not restrict the HAS derivative to the open structure.
  • the ring structure is shown in some cases.
  • the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein L bridging M and A is a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId), preferably consisting of a structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • L 1 and L 2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R′′ wherein R′′ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl; more preferably H, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6,
  • HAS preferably HES can be reacted via carbon atom C* of the terminal reducing end of the starch with amino group M of the crosslinking compound wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M.
  • the HAS is reacted via the reducing end” or “the HAS is reacted via carbon atom C* of the terminal reducing end” as used in the context of the present invention may relate to a process according to which the HAS is reacted predominantly via its (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end.
  • This term “predominantly via its (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end” relates to processes according to which statistically more than 50%, preferably at least 55%, more preferably at least 60%, more preferably at least 65%, more preferably at least 70%, more preferably at least 75%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and still more preferably at least 95% such as 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% of the HAS molecules employed for a given reaction are reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end per HAS molecule, wherein a given HAS molecule which is reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end can be reacted in the same given reaction via at least one further suitable functional group which is comprised in said polymer molecule and which is not a reducing end.
  • HAS molecule(s) is (are) reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end and simultaneously via at least one further suitable functional group which is comprised in this (these) HAS molecule(s) and which is not a (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end, statistically preferably more than 50%, preferably at least 55%, more preferably at least 60%, more preferably at least 65%, more preferably at least 70%, more preferably at least 75%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and still more preferably at least 95% such as 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% of all reacted functional groups of these HAS molecules, said functional groups including the (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing ends, are (selectively oxidised) reducing ends.
  • reducing end as used in the context of the present invention relates to the terminal aldehyde group of a HAS molecule which may be present as aldehyde group and/or as corresponding hemiacetal form and/or as acetal group, the acetal group having the following structure
  • the oxidised reducing end is in the form of a carboxy group and/or of the corresponding lactone.
  • the crosslinking compound is reacted via the amino group with the oxidised C* atom of the terminal reducing end of HAS, preferably HES.
  • the oxidation may be carried out according to all suitable method or methods resulting in the oxidised reducing end of hydroxyalkyl starch, it is preferably carried out using an alkaline iodine solution as described, e.g., in Sommermeyer et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,083,909, column 5, lines 63-67, and column 7, lines 25-39; column 8, line 53 to column 9, line 20, the respective content being incorporated into the present invention by reference.
  • HES preferably a lactone
  • carboxylic acid such as alkali metal salt, preferably as sodium and/or potassium salt, and HAS′ preferably being HES′.
  • this form of the HAS preferably HES, is reacted as such with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound.
  • the HAS preferably HES, selectively oxidised at its reducing end
  • a suitable compound to give the HAS, preferably HES, comprising a reactive carboxy group.
  • the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with at least one alcohol, preferably with at least one acidic alcohol such as acidic alcohols having a pK A value in the range of from 6 to 12 or of from 7 to 11 at 25° C.
  • the molecular weight of the acidic alcohol may be in the range of from 80 to 500 g/mol, such as of from 90 to 300 g/mol or of from 100 to 200 g/mol.
  • Suitable acidic alcohols are all alcohols H—O—R A having an acidic proton and are capable of being reacted with the oxidised HAS to give the respective reactive HAS ester, preferably according to the formula
  • N-hydroxy succinimides such as N-hydroxy succinimde or sulfo-N-hydroxy succinimide, suitably substituted phenols such as p-nitrophenol, o,p-dinitrophenol, o,o′-dinitrophenol, trichlorophenol such as 2,4,6-trichlorophenol or 2,4,5-trichlorophenol, trifluorophenol such as 2,4,6-trifluorophenol or 2,4,5-trifluorophenol, pentachlorophenol, pentafluorophenol, or hydroxyazoles such as hydroxy benzotriazole.
  • phenols such as p-nitrophenol, o,p-dinitrophenol, o,o′-dinitrophenol
  • trichlorophenol such as 2,4,6-trichlorophenol or 2,4,5-trichlorophenol
  • trifluorophenol such as 2,4,6-trifluorophenol or 2,4,5-trifluorophenol
  • pentachlorophenol pentafluorophenol
  • N-hydroxy succinimides are especially preferred.
  • All alcohols may be employed alone or as suitable combination of two or more thereof.
  • the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with at least one carbonic diester R B —O—(C ⁇ O)—O—R C , wherein R B and R C may be the same or different.
  • this method gives reactive HAS according to the formula
  • HAS′ is preferably HES′.
  • compounds may be employed whose alcohol components are independently N-hydroxy succinimides such as N-hydroxy succinimde or sulfo-N-hydroxy succinimide, suitably substituted phenols such as p-nitrophenol, o,p-dinitrophenol, o,o′-dinitrophenol, trichlorophenol such as 2,4,6-trichlorophenol or 2,4,5-trichlorophenol, trifluorophenol such as 2,4,6-trifluorophenol or 2,4,5-trifluorophenol, pentachlorophenol, pentafluorophenol, or hydroxyazoles such as hydroxy benzotriazole.
  • N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate and sulfo-N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate are especially preferred.
  • the present invention also relates a method as described above, wherein the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is activated by reacting the oxidised HAS with N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate.
  • the acidic alcohol is reacted with the oxidised HAS or the salt of the oxidised HAS at a molar ratio of acidic alcohol:HAS preferably of from 5:1 to 50:1, more preferably of from 8:1 to 20:1, at a preferred reaction temperature of from 2 to 40° C., more preferably of from 10 to 30° C. and especially preferably of from 15 to 25° C.
  • the reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 to 10 h, more preferably of from 2 to 5 h, more preferably of from 2 to 4 h and particularly of from 2 to 3 h.
  • the carbonic diester compound is reacted with the oxidised HAS or the salt of the oxidised HAS at a molar ratio of diester compound:HAS generally of from 1:1 to 3:1, such as of from 1:1 to 1.5:1.
  • the reaction time is generally in the range of from 0.1 to 12 h, like of from 0.2 to 6 h, or of from 0.5 to 2 h or of from 0.75 to 1.25 h.
  • reacting the oxidised HAS with acidic alcohol and/or carbonic diester is carried out in at least one aprotic solvent, such as in an anhydrous aprotic solvent having a water content of not more than 0.5 percent by weight, preferably of not more than 0.1 percent by weight.
  • aprotic solvent such as in an anhydrous aprotic solvent having a water content of not more than 0.5 percent by weight, preferably of not more than 0.1 percent by weight.
  • Suitable solvents are, among others, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), N-methylpyrrolidone, dimethyl acetamide (DMA), dimethyl formamide (DMF) and mixtures of two or more thereof.
  • the reaction temperatures are preferably in the range of from 2 to 40° C., more preferably of from 10 to 30° C.
  • At least one additional activating agent is employed.
  • Suitable activating agents are, among others, carbonyldiimidazole, carbodiimides such as diisopropyl carbodiimde (DIC), dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC), 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC), with dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC) and 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC) being especially preferred.
  • carbodiimides such as diisopropyl carbodiimde (DIC), dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC), 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC), with dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC) and 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC) being especially
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, where the HAS which is oxidised at its reducing end, is reacted with an acidic alcohol in the presence of an additional activating agent to give the reactive HAS ester.
  • the reaction of the oxidised HAS with carbonic diester and/or acidic alcohol is carried out at a low base activity which may be determined by adding the reaction mixture to water with a volume ratio of water to reaction mixture of 10:1.
  • the water which comprises essentially no buffer Prior to the addition, has a pH value of 7 at 25° C.
  • the base activity of the reaction mixture is obtained, having a value of preferably not more than 9.0, more preferably of not more than 8.0 and especially preferably of not more than 7.5.
  • the oxidised HAS is reacted with N-hydroxy succinimide in dry DMA in the absence of water with EDC to selectively give the polymer N-hydroxy succinimide ester according to the formula
  • HAS′ being HES′.
  • This reaction does not give by-products resulting from reactions of EDC with OH groups of HES, and the rearrangement reaction of the O-acyl isourea formed by EDC and the oxidised HAS to the respective N-acyl urea is surprisingly suppressed.
  • the oxidised HAS is reacted with N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate in dry DMF in the absence of water and in the absence of an activating agent to selectively give the HAS-N-hydroxy succinimide ester according to the formula
  • HAS′ being HES′.
  • the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with an azolide such as carbonyldiimidazole or carbonyl dibenzimidazole to give a polymer having a reactive carboxy group.
  • an azolide such as carbonyldiimidazole or carbonyl dibenzimidazole to give a polymer having a reactive carboxy group.
  • carbonyldiimidazole a reactive imidazolide HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS′ is preferably HES′.
  • the reactive HAS derivative comprising at least one reactive carboxy group, preferably resulting from the reaction of the HAS with the acidic alcohol, the carbonate and/or the azolide, as described above, is then further reacted with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound M.
  • Reaction of the HAS via the oxidised reducing end, optionally further activated as described above, with amino group M can be carried out according to all suitable methods.
  • the amino group M is a primary amino group H 2 N— or a secondary amino group.
  • polar aprotic solvents are used which may also contain a certain amount of water, such as up to 10 wt.-%.
  • Preferred aprotic solvents are, among others, DMSO or DMF.
  • An example of a preferred reaction temperature range is from 0 to 80° C., more preferably from 0 to 70° C., more preferably from 0 to 60° C., more preferably from 0 to 50° C. and even more preferably from 0 to 40° C.
  • a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an amid bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted via its oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H 2 N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 80° C., and wherein X is —(C ⁇ O)—NH—.
  • the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative, obtainable or obtained by the method as described above.
  • the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative as such, having the following structure
  • R′ is H if the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a primary amino group, and wherein R′ is a chemical moiety other than H if the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a secondary amino group.
  • R′ is dependent on the crosslinking compound, and thus, reference is made to the discussion of the generally possible and preferably employed crosslinking compounds hereinabove.
  • HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention.
  • the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18) are more preferred. Even more preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). Particularly preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • the present invention relates to a HES derivative having the following structure:
  • HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the crosslinking compound is reacted via amino group with the non-oxidised C* atom of the terminal reducing end of HAS, preferably HES, i.e. the terminal aldehyde group of a HAS molecule may be present as aldehyde group and/or as corresponding hemiacetal form.
  • Reaction of the HAS via the non-oxidised reducing end, with amino group M can be carried out according to all suitable methods.
  • the amino group M is H 2 N—, a suitable secondary amino group HNR′— such as, e.g., H 3 C—NH—, H 2 N—O—, or a suitable secondary hydroxyamino group HNR′—O— such as, e.g., H 3 C—NH—O—, or H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—.
  • the amino group M is H 2 N—, H 2 N—O— or H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, even more preferably H 2 N— or H 2 N—O—, and in particular H 2 N—.
  • this reaction is carried out in an aqueous system.
  • aqueous system refers to a solvent or a mixture of solvents comprising water in the range of from at least 10% per weight, preferably at least 50% per weight, more preferably at least 80% per weight, even more preferably at least 90% per weight or up to 100% per weight, based on the weight of the solvents involved.
  • solvents such as DMSO, DMF, ethanol or methanol may be mentioned.
  • the temperature of the reaction is preferably in the range of from 5 to 45° C., more preferably in the range of from 10 to 30° C. and especially preferably in the range of from 15 to 25° C.
  • the temperature is preferably in the range of up to 100° C., more preferably in the range of from 10 to 90° C., more preferably in the range of from 20 to 80° C., more preferably in the range of from 30 to 70° C. and especially preferably in the range of from 40 to 60° C.
  • the temperature may be varied, preferably in the above-given ranges, or held essentially constant.
  • the reaction time for the reaction of HAS with crosslinking compound M may be adapted to the specific needs and is generally in the range of from 1 h to 7 d.
  • the reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 h to 3 d, more preferably of from 2 h to 48 h, and especially preferably of from 3 to 24 h.
  • the reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 h to 7 d, more preferably in the range of from 4 h to 6 d, more preferably in the range of from 8 h to 5 d and even more preferably in the range of from 16 h to 3 d.
  • the pH value for the reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound may be adapted to the specific needs such as the chemical nature of the reactants.
  • group M of the crosslinking compound is a hydroxylamine or a hydrazide
  • the pH value is preferably in the range of from 3 to 9, more preferably of from 4 to 8 and even more preferably of from 4.5 to 6.5.
  • the pH value is preferably in the range of from 3 to 9, more preferably in the range of from 3.5 to 8, and even more preferably in the range of from 4 to 6.
  • the suitable pH value of the reaction mixture may be adjusted, for each reaction step, by adding at least one suitable buffer.
  • suitable buffers acetate buffers, preferably sodium acetate buffer, phosphate or borate buffers may be mentioned.
  • a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an imine bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an amine bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H 2 N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 20 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4 to 7, X being —CH ⁇ N—.
  • the present invention also relates to the above-described method, wherein in (i), the reaction is carried out in the presence of a reducing agent, such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex, preferably NaCNBH 3 , to obtain a HAS derivative, X being —CH 2 —NH—.
  • a reducing agent such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride
  • organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane
  • the concentration of these reducing agents used for the reductive amination of the present invention is preferably in the range of from 0.01 to 2.0 mol/l, more preferably in the range of from 0.05 to 1.5 mol/l, and more preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 1.0 mol/l, relating, in each case, to the volume of the reaction solution.
  • the molar ratio of crosslinking compound:HAS is preferably in the range of from 1:1 to 100:1, more preferably from 2:1 to 80:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 70:1, more preferably from 4:1 to 60:1, and more preferably from 5:1 to 50:1.
  • the concentration of HAS, preferably HES, in the aqueous system is preferably in the range of from 1 to 50 wt.-%, more preferably from 3 to 45 wt.-%, and more preferably from 5 to 40 wt.-%, relating, in each case, to the weight of the reaction solution.
  • a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an —CH ⁇ N—O— bond or —CH ⁇ N—NH—(C ⁇ O)— bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via a —CH 2 —NH—O— bond or —CH 2 —NH—NH—(C ⁇ O)— bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H 2 N—O— or H 2 N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 5 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4.5 to 6.5, X being —CH ⁇ N—O— or —CH ⁇ N—NH—(C ⁇ O)—.
  • the present invention also relates to the above-described method, wherein in (i), the reaction is carried out in the presence of a reducing agent, such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex, preferably NaCNBH 3 , to obtain a HAS derivative, X being —CH 2 —NH—O— or —CH 2 —NH—NH—(C ⁇ O)—.
  • a reducing agent such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride
  • organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane
  • the concentration of these reducing agents used for this reaction of the present invention is preferably in the range of from 0.001 to 2.0 mol/l, more preferably in the range of from 0.01 to 1.0 mol/l, and more preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 0.8 mol/l, relating, in each case, to the volume of the reaction solution.
  • the molar ratio of crosslinking compound:HAS is preferably in the range of from 1:1 to 100:1, more preferably from 2:1 to 80:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 70:1, more preferably from 4:1 to 60:1, and more preferably from 5:1 to 50:1.
  • the concentration of HAS, preferably HES, in the aqueous system is preferably in the range of from 1 to 50 wt.-%, more preferably from 3 to 45 wt.-%, and more preferably from 5 to 40 wt.-%, relating, in each case, to the weight of the reaction solution.
  • the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative, obtainable or obtained by the method(s) as described above.
  • the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative as such, having the following structure
  • the C—N double bond may be present in E or Z conformation where also a mixture of both forms may be present having a certain equilibrium distribution; or, as far as the corresponding ring structure is concerned which for the purposes of the present invention shall be regarded as identical to the open structure above,
  • these HAS derivatives may be present with the N atom in equatorial or axial position where also a mixture of both forms may be present having a certain equilibrium distribution;
  • HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention.
  • the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18) are more preferred. Even more preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). Particularly preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • the present invention relates to a HES derivative having the following structure:
  • HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • HAS has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more
  • HAS is oxidised prior to the reaction with the crosslinking compound such that at least two aldehyde groups would be introduced into HAS according to the following formula
  • each oxidation agent or combination of oxidation agents might be employed capable of oxidising at least one saccharide ring of the polymer to give an opened saccharide ring having at least one, preferably at least two aldehyde groups.
  • This reaction might be illustrated by the following reaction scheme showing a saccharide ring of HAS which is oxidised to give an opened ring having two aldehyde groups:
  • Suitable oxidising agents are, among others, periodates such as alkaline metal periodates or mixtures of two or more thereof, with sodium periodate and potassium periodate being preferred. It might be conceivable that these aldehyde groups could be reacted with the crosslinking compound M-L-A via amino group M.
  • the HAS derivative from step (i) of the present invention is subsequently reacted as described hereinunder.
  • the HAS derivative from step (i) is suitably purified after the reaction step (i).
  • the HAS derivative is preferably obtained as a solid.
  • HAS derivative solutions or frozen HAS derivative solutions may be mentioned having preferred HAS derivative contents of from 2 to 40 wt.-%, wherein the pH of these solutions is preferably in a range of from 3 to 10 and the concentration of the buffer used is preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 1 mol/l.
  • the present invention also relates to a method as described above, wherein, after (i), the HAS derivative obtained in (i) is purified using ultrafiltration using water or an aqueous buffer solution having a concentration of from 0.1 to 100 mmol/l, a pH in the range of from 2 to 10, the number of exchange cycles being from 10 to 50.
  • the present invention relates to a method wherein above-described HES derivative
  • a biologically active compound BA is further suitably reacted with a biologically active compound BA via acetal or ketal group A, which group A is preferably transformed to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group prior to the reaction with BA.
  • group A preferably the corresponding aldehyde or keto group is reacted with an amino group, still more preferably with a primary amino group comprised in BA.
  • BA is also represented as H 2 N-BA′ wherein BA′ is the remainder of BA.
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, further comprising
  • the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is suitably subjected to a transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group wherein the resulting HAS derivative is subjected to a suitable purification and/or isolation step prior to the reaction with BA.
  • the transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction.
  • the reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C.
  • Purification and buffer-exchange of the hydrolysis reaction product can be achieved by methods well-known to those skilled in the art, e.g. by dialysis or ultrafiltration.
  • the transformed material can be recovered from the solution as a solid e.g. by freeze-drying.
  • the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is suitably subjected to a transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group wherein the resulting HAS derivative is directly reacted with BA, i.e. without a separate suitable purification and/or isolation step of the HAS derivative comprising the aldehyde or keto group.
  • the transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction. The reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C.
  • the hydrolysis reaction product can be combined with the BA in a buffered solution either directly or after having adjusted the pH to a value compatible with the reaction with the BA.
  • the present invention also relates to a method as described above wherein prior to (ii), group A of the HAS derivative according to formula (III) is transformed to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group.
  • the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is directly reacted with BA, i.e. reacted with BA under reaction conditions allowing for the in situ transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group without a separate suitable purification and/or isolation step and without a separate step for the transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group.
  • the transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction.
  • the reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C.
  • the hydrolysis reaction product can be combined with the BA in a buffered solution either directly or after having adjusted the pH to a value compatible with the reaction with the BA.
  • the reaction in step (ii) is preferably carried out in an aqueous system.
  • aqueous system refers to a solvent or a mixture of solvents comprising water in the range of from at least 10% per weight, preferably at least 50% per weight, more preferably at least 80% per weight, even more preferably at least 90% per weight or up to 100% per weight, based on the weight of the solvents involved.
  • solvents such as DMSO, DMF, ethanol or methanol may be mentioned.
  • step (ii) While it is conceivable to carry out the reaction in step (ii) under conditions to obtain the non-reduced form of the HAS derivative according to formula (IV), i.e.
  • step (ii) it is particularly preferred to carry out the reaction according to step (ii) under reductive amination conditions in the presence of at least one suitable reducing agent.
  • at least one suitable reducing agent for example, under these conditions the group —CH ⁇ N— obtained through the reaction of the aldehyde or keto group resulting from group A of the HAS derivative and the H 2 N-group of BA is reduced to —CH 2 —NH—.
  • the following reducing agents may be employed: NaBH(OAc) 3 , sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex.
  • NaBH 4 and NaCNBH 3 are preferred, and NaCNBH 3 is particularly preferred.
  • the HAS derivative is added to an aqueous solution containing the biologically active agent.
  • the at least one reducing agent is added, in particular NaCNBH 3 .
  • the HAS derivative may be optionally brought into an aqueous solution, and then BA is added.
  • the at least one reducing agent is added, in particular NaCNBH 3 .
  • the reaction of the HAS derivative with the amino group of the biologically active compound BA in step (ii) is preferably carried out at a pH value of from 3 to 9, preferably of from 3 to 8, more preferably of from 3 to 7, more preferably from 3 to below 7, such as at a pH of 3 or 4 or 5 or 6.
  • the suitable pH value of the reaction mixture may be adjusted by adding at least one suitable buffer.
  • acetate buffers preferably sodium acetate buffer, phosphate or borate buffers may be mentioned.
  • the reaction of the HAS derivative obtained in step b) with the amino group of the biologically active compound BA in step (ii) is preferably carried out at a temperature of from ⁇ 10 to 100° C., preferably of from 0 to 50° C., more preferably of from 0 to 37° C., more preferably of from 0 to 25° C., such as 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, or 25° C.
  • reaction time in step (ii) depends on the temperature, the ratio of HAS, in particular HES, derivative and compound BA and the absolute concentration of the HAS derivative and compound BA. Generally, reaction times from 5 min to 7 d, preferably from 1 h to 7 d are conceivable.
  • the molar ratio of HAS derivative obtained to compound BA in step (ii) is preferably from 0:1 to 200:1 equivalents, even more preferably from 1:1 to 100:1, based on the number average molecular weight (M n ) of the HAS derivative.
  • the molar ratio is from 1:1 to 50:1.
  • Low molar ratios such as molar ratios of 50:1 or below, preferably from 1:1 to 20:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 10:1, and even more preferably from 2:1 to 9:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 8:1 and even more preferably from 4:1 to 7:1, are conceivable, for example, if BA is a protein, in particular IFN alpha.
  • the concentration of the HAS derivative used in step (ii) is higher than about 10 wt.-%, in particular higher than about 15 wt.-%, in each case related to the weight of the reaction solution of (ii).
  • the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (ii), the reaction is carried out, preferably in an aqueous system, in the presence of a reducing agent, preferably NaCNBH 3 , at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 37° C., preferably 0 to 25° C. and a pH in the range of from 3 to 9, preferably 3 to below 7, and wherein in (ii), the molar ratio of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA is from 0.1:1 to 200:1 equivalents, preferably from 1:1 to 50:1 equivalents, based on the number average molecular weight (M n ) of the HAS derivative.
  • a reducing agent preferably NaCNBH 3
  • Preferred concentrations of BA such as, e.g., preferred protein concentrations of the solution, preferably the aqueous solution, subjected to (ii) are in the range of from 0.1 to 10 g/l, more preferably from 1 to 9 g/l.
  • concentration of the HAS derivative in said solution, prior to (ii) and given in (w/v) is preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 50%, more preferably from 0.5 to 45% and more preferably from 1 to 40%.
  • the biologically active agent BA may be dissolved in an aqueous medium, preferably in an aqueous buffer solution, in particular in a sodium acetate buffer solution.
  • the aqueous solution additionally may contain additives, such as detergents and/or dispersants, in particular selected from the group consisting of SDS, Chaps, Tween 20, Tween 80, Nonidet P-40, and Triton X 100. If a detergent and/or dispersant is used, it is preferably present in an amount of 0.005 to 3 wt.-%, preferably of 0.05 to 3 wt.-%, preferably about 0.5 wt.-%, based on the total weight of the aqueous solution.
  • X present in the HAS derivative employed for the reaction with BA, is, e.g., —CH ⁇ N—, —CH ⁇ N—O—, or —CH ⁇ N—NH—(C ⁇ O)— is preferably reduced to result in a functional group X, being —CH 2 —NH—, —CH 2 —NH—O—, or —CH 2 —NH—NH—(C ⁇ O)— under the reductive amination conditions used for the reaction in (ii).
  • the present invention thus also relates to the HAS derivative obtained or obtainable by the method as described above, in particular by a method as described above wherein in (ii), the reaction is carried out, preferably in an aqueous system, in the presence of a reducing agent, preferably NaCNBH 3 , at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 37° C., preferably 0 to 25° C.
  • a reducing agent preferably NaCNBH 3
  • the molar ratio of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA is from 0.1:1 to 200:1 equivalents, preferably from 1:1 to 10:1 equivalents, based on the number average molecular weight (M n ) of the HAS derivative employed in step (ii), in each case with the proviso that X is not an amid group.
  • Particularly preferred molar ratios of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA are below 10, such from 1:1 to 9:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 8:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 7:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 6:1 and even more preferably from 1:1 to 5:1, such as about 1:1, about 2:1, about 3:1, about 4:1, or about 5:1. While such low molar ratios like molar ratios of 50:1 or below, more preferably of 10:1 or below are conceivable for several biologically active agents, they are preferred for e.g. proteins wherein IFN alpha is especially preferred.
  • molar ratios of 50:1 or below such as, e.g., from 1:1 to 50:1, are preferred.
  • molar ratios in the range of from 1:1 to 50:1 or from 2:1 to 40:1 or from 3:1 to 30:1 or from 4:1 to 20:1 or from 5:1 to 15:1 may be mentioned.
  • a protein is employed as biologically active agent BA according to the present invention, and especially at the preferred pH ranges given above, particularly at a pH below 7 and greater or equal 3, to react the HAS derivative predominantly with the amino group located at the N terminus of the protein.
  • the term “predominantly” as used in the context of the present invention relates to an embodiment where at least 50%, preferably at least 60%, preferably at least 70%, preferably at least 80%, preferably at least 85% of the N-terminal amino groups available are reacted via reductive amination. It is also possible to react at least 90% or at least 95% or at least 96% or at least 97% or at least 98% or at least 99% of the N-terminal amino groups available.
  • the present invention also relates to a method for the preparation of a HAS derivative comprising BA′, a HAS derivative obtainable or obtained by such method, and a HAS derivative according to formula (IV) as such, as described above, wherein the protein comprises the N-terminal amino group and at least one further amino group, said HAS derivative comprising the HAS being predominantly coupled to the N-terminal amino group.
  • the present invention also relates to a HAS derivative according to formula (IV)
  • the present invention also relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative of formula (IV)
  • X is not an amide group —C( ⁇ O)—NH—, with hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
  • Z 1 and Z 2 are each independently O or S or NR x , preferably O, wherein R x is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl such as n-propyl or i-propyl, or C(O)—R y wherein R y is preferably selected from the group consisting of C 1 -C 6 alkyl and C 6 -C 14 aryl, even more preferably selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl; R x preferably being H; A 1 and A 2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzy
  • a 1 and A 2 taken together, are —(CH 2 ) 2 — or —(CH 2 ) 3 — or —(CH 2 CH(CH 3 ))—, and wherein A 3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, A 3 preferably being H.; and wherein L is a spacer bridging M and A, wherein BA′ is the remainder of a biologically active agent BA′-NH 2 remaining after the reaction of the amino group of BA via reductive amination with A or with the aldehyde group or keto group corresponding to A.
  • HAS preferably HES
  • crosslinking compound preferably HES
  • X is preferably selected from the group consisting of —CH 2 —NH—, —CH ⁇ N—, —CH 2 —NH—O—, and —CH ⁇ N—O—, more preferably —CH 2 —NH— and —CH 2 —NH—O—, most preferably —CH 2 —NH—.
  • L bridging M and A is preferably a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId), preferably consisting of a structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • L 1 and L 2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R′′ wherein R′′ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl; more preferably H, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6,
  • biologically active substance as used in the context of the present invention relates to a substance which can affect any physical or biochemical property of a biological organism including, but not limited to, viruses, bacteria, fungi, plants, animals, and humans.
  • biologically active substance as used in the context of the present invention relates to a substance intended for diagnosis, cure, mitigation, treatment, or prevention of disease in humans or animals, or to otherwise enhance physical or mental well-being of humans or animals.
  • active substances include, but are not limited to, peptides, polypeptides, proteins, enzymes, small molecule drugs, dyes, lipids, nucleosides, nucleotides, oligonucleotides such as, e.g., oligonucleotides having a suitable spacer such as 5′-aminohexyl spacer, polynucleotides, nucleic acids, cells, viruses, liposomes, microparticles, and micelles.
  • a biologically active substance according to the present invention contains a native amino group.
  • proteins include, but are not limited to, erythropoietin (EPO), such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO) or an EPO mimetic, colony-stimulating factors (CSF), such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), alpha-Interferon (IFN alpha), beta-Interferon (IFN beta) or gamma-Interferon (IFN gamma), such as IFN alpha and IFN beta like recombinant human IFN alpha or IFN beta (rhIFN alpha or rhIFN beta), interleukines, e.g.
  • IL-1 to IL-34 such as IL-2 or IL-3 or IL-11 like recombinant human IL-2 or IL-3 (rhIL-2 or rhIL-3), serum proteins such as coagulation factors II-XIII like factor VIII, factor VII, factor IX, factor II, factor III, factor IV, factor V, factor VI, factor X, factor XI, factor XII, factor XIII, serine protease inhibitors such as alpha1-antitrypsin (A1AT), activated protein C (APC), plasminogen activators such as tissue-type plasminogen activator (tPA), such as human tissue plasminogen activator (hTPA), AT III such as recombinant human AT III (rhAT III), myoglobin, albumin such as bovine serum albumin (BSA), growth factors, such as epidermal growth factor (EGF), thrombocyte growth factor (PDGF), fibroblast growth factor (FGF), brain-derived growth factor (BDGF), nerve growth
  • melanoside-stimulating hormones lipoproteins and apo-lipoproteins such as apo-B, apo-E, apo-L a
  • immunoglobulins such as IgG, IgE, IgM, IgA, IgD and fragments thereof, such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), murin immunoglobuline G (mIgG), hirudin, tissue-pathway inhibitor, plant proteins such as lectin or ricin, bee-venom, snake-venom, immunotoxins, antigen E, alpha-proteinase inhibitor, ragweed allergen, melanin, oligolysine proteins, RGD proteins or optionally corresponding receptors for one of these proteins; prolactin or a mutant thereof, such as G129R, in which the wild type amino acid at position 129, glycine, is replaced by arginine (a tradename of this mutant is “LactoVert”) and
  • the polypeptide is preferably selected from the group consisting of erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide
  • the polypeptide is selected from the group consisting of erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptid
  • the active substance is preferably selected from the group composed of antibiotics, antidepressants, antidiabetics, antidiuretics, anticholinergics, antiarrhythmics, antiemetics, antitussives, antiepileptics, antihistamines, antimycotics, antisympathotonics, antithrombotics, androgens, antiandrogens, estrogens, antiestrogens, antiosteoporotics, antitumor agents, vasodilators, other antihypertensive agents, antipyretic agents, analgesics, antiinflammatory agents, beta blockers, immunosuppressants and vitamins.
  • antibiotics antibiotics, antidepressants, antidiabetics, antidiuretics, anticholinergics, antiarrhythmics, antiemetics, antitussives, antiepileptics, antihistamines, antimycotics, antisympathotonics, antithrombotics, androgens, antiandrog
  • active substances are alendronate, amikazin, atenolol, azathioprine, cimetidine, clonidine, cosyntropin, cycloserine, desmopressin, dihydroergotamine, dobutamine, dopamine, epsilon-aminocaproic acid, ergometrine, esmolol, famotidine, flecamide, folic acid, flucytosine, furosemide, ganciclovir, glucagon, hydrazaline, isoproterenol, ketamine, liothyronine, LHRH, merpatricin, methyldopa, metoprolol, neomicin, nimodipine, nystatin, oxytocin, phentolamine, phenylephrine, procainamide, procaine, propranolol, rito
  • E. coli rAsparaginae
  • anthracyclines bexarotene, bicalutamide, bleomycin, buserelin, busulfan, cabergoline, capecitabine, carboplatin, carmustine, chlorambucin, cilastatin sodium, cisplatin, cladribine, clodronate, cyclophosphamide, cyproterone, cytarabine, camptothecins, 13-cis retinoic acid, all trans retinoic acid; dacarbazine, dactinomycin, daunorubicin, deferoxamine, dexamethasone, diclofenac, diethylstilbestrol, docetaxel, doxorubicin, epirubicin, estramustine, etoposide, exemestane, fexofenadine, fludarabine, fludrocortisone, fluorouraci
  • small molecules also chemical compounds known to the skilled person as “small molecules” are conceivable biologically active substances according to the present invention.
  • the term “small molecule” as used in this context of the present invention relates to a biologically active chemical compound other than a protein and an oligonucleotide, including, however, peptides of up to 50 amino acids. Typical examples of such small molecules are listed in the foregoing paragraph.
  • oligonucleotide examples include aptamers and siRNA. Also to be mentioned are peptide nucleic acids (PNA) as conceivable biologically active substances.
  • PNA peptide nucleic acids
  • the present invention also relates to a method as described above and a HAS derivative as described above, wherein the protein is erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G such
  • alternative protein scaffold as used in the context of the present invention relates to a molecule having binding abilities similar to a given antibody wherein the molecule is based on an alternative non-antibody protein framework.
  • alternative protein scaffold as used in the context of the present invention relates to a molecule having binding abilities similar to a given antibody wherein the molecule is based on an alternative non-antibody protein framework.
  • these compounds may comprise one or more amino groups for coupling according to stage (ii) of the present invention.
  • BA biologically active substances
  • these compounds may comprise one or more amino groups for coupling according to stage (ii) of the present invention.
  • at least one such amino group is introduced into BA by suitable functionalisation via methods known to the skilled person, prior to subjecting BA to (ii).
  • HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention
  • BA′ is a protein, more preferably, wherein the protein is erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor Vila (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobulin G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like
  • HAS′ is HES′, wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight of from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, preferably of 0.7 to 1.3, such as 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, most preferably about 1.0, 1.1, 1.2 or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from, 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C 2 :C 6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above, for use in a method for the treatment of the human or animal body.
  • the present invention relates to a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above, as a therapeutic or prophylactic agent.
  • the present invention relates to a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising in a therapeutically effective amount a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above.
  • the HAS derivatives of the present invention may be administered by suitable methods such as e.g. enteral, parenteral or pulmonary methods preferably administered by i.v., s.c. or i.m. routes.
  • suitable methods such as e.g. enteral, parenteral or pulmonary methods preferably administered by i.v., s.c. or i.m. routes.
  • the specific route chosen will depend upon the condition being treated.
  • the derivatives may be administered together with a suitable carrier, such as known in the art (e.g. as used in the first generation/unmodified biopharmaceutical, albumin-free or with albumin as an excipient), a suitable diluent, such as sterile solutions for i.v., i.m., or s.c. application.
  • the required dosage will depend on the severity of the condition being treated, the patient's individual response, the method of administration used, and the like. The skilled person is able to establish a correct dosage based on his
  • the HAS derivatives may be used in combination with a pharmaceutical excipient.
  • the HAS derivative will be in a solid form which can be combined with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient that can be in either solid or liquid form.
  • carbohydrates, inorganic salts, antimicrobial agents, antioxidants, surfactants, buffers, acids, bases, and combinations thereof may be mentioned.
  • a carbohydrate such as a sugar, a derivatized sugar such as an alditol, aldonic acid, an esterified sugar, and/or a sugar polymer may be present as an excipient.
  • carbohydrate excipients include, for example: monosaccharides, such as fructose, maltose, galactose, glucose, D-mannose, sorbose, and the like; disaccharides, such as lactose, sucrose, trehalose, cellobiose, and the like; polysaccharides, such as raffinose, melezitose, maltodextrins, dextrans, starches, and the like; and alditols, such as mannitol, xylitol, maltitol, lactitol, xylitol, sorbitol (glucitol), pyranosyl sorbitol, myoinositol, and the like.
  • monosaccharides such as fructose, maltose, galactose, glucose, D-mannose, sorbose, and the like
  • disaccharides such as lactose,
  • the excipient may also include an inorganic salt or buffer such as citric acid, sodium chloride, potassium chloride, sodium sulfate, potassium nitrate, sodium phosphate monobasic, sodium phosphate dibasic, and combinations thereof.
  • the pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise an antimicrobial agent for preventing or deterring microbial growth, such as, e.g., benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride, benzyl alcohol, cetylpyridinium chloride, chlorobutanol, phenol, phenylethyl alcohol, phenylmercuric nitrate, thimersol, and combinations thereof.
  • the pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise an antioxidant, such as, e.g., ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, hypophosphorous acid, monothioglycerol, propyl gallate, sodium bisulfite, sodium formaldehyde sulfoxylate, sodium metabisulfite, and combinations thereof.
  • an antioxidant such as, e.g., ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, hypophosphorous acid, monothioglycerol, propyl gallate, sodium bisulfite, sodium formaldehyde sulfoxylate, sodium metabisulfite, and combinations thereof.
  • the pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise a surfactant, such as, e.g., polysorbates, or pluronics sorbitan esters; lipids, such as phospholipids such as lecithin and other phosphatidylcholines, phosphatidylethanolamines acids and fatty esters; steroids, such as cholesterol; and chelating agents, such as EDTA or zinc.
  • a surfactant such as, e.g., polysorbates, or pluronics sorbitan esters
  • lipids such as phospholipids such as lecithin and other phosphatidylcholines, phosphatidylethanolamines acids and fatty esters
  • steroids such as cholesterol
  • chelating agents such as EDTA or zinc.
  • the pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise acids or bases such as, e.g., hydrochloric acid, acetic acid, phosphoric acid, citric acid, malic acid, lactic acid, formic acid, trichloroacetic acid, nitric acid, perchloric acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, fumaric acid, and combinations thereof, and/or sodium hydroxide, sodium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, ammonium acetate, potassium acetate, sodium phosphate, potassium phosphate, sodium citrate, sodium formate, sodium sulfate, potassium sulfate, potassium fumerate, and combinations thereof.
  • acids or bases such as, e.g., hydrochloric acid, acetic acid, phosphoric acid, citric acid, malic acid, lactic acid, formic acid, trichloroacetic acid, nitric acid, perchloric acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, fumaric acid, and
  • the excipient will be present in pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention in an amount of 0.001 to 99.999 wt.-%, preferably from 0.01 to 99.99 wt.-%, more preferably from 0.1 to 99.9 wt.-%, in each case based on the total weight of the pharmaceutical composition.
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is EPO, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of anemic disorders or hematopoietic dysfunction disorders or diseases related hereto.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is EPO
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is G-CSF, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of haemophilia A for the treatment of a disorder characterized by a reduced hematopoietic or immune function.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is G-CSF
  • BA is G-CSF
  • the disorder characterized by a reduced hematopoietic or immune function is a result of chemotherapy, radiation therapy, infectious disease, severe chronic neutropenia, or leukemia.
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN alpha, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of leukaemia e.g. hairy cell leukaemia, chronic myelogeneous leukaemia, multiple myeloma, follicular lymphoma, cancer, e.g. carcinoid tumour, malignant melanoma and hepatitis, e.g. chronic hepatitis B and chronic hepatitis C.
  • leukaemia e.g. hairy cell leukaemia, chronic myelogeneous leukaemia, multiple myeloma, follicular lymphoma, cancer, e.g. carcinoid tumour, malignant melanoma and hepatitis, e.g. chronic hepatitis B and chronic hepatitis C.
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN gamma, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of osteoporosis and/or chronic malignant disease.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN gamma
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-2, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of osteoporosis and/or chronic malignant disease.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-2
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-11, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of platelet transfusions following myelosuppressive chemotherapy.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-11
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is A1AT, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of emphysema, cystic fibrosis, atopic dermatitis, and/or bronchitis.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is A1AT
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN beta, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of multiple sclerosis, preferably relapsing forms of multiple sclerosis.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN beta
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is factor VII for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of episodes in hemophilia A or B patients with inhibitors to Factor VIII or Factor IX.
  • the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is factor IX for the preparation of a medicament for the control and prevention of hemorrhagic episodes in patients with hemophilia B, e.g. congenital factor IX deficiency or Christmas disease, including control and prevention of bleeding in surgical settings.
  • a HAS derivative preferably a HES derivative as described above
  • BA is factor IX for the preparation of a medicament for the control and prevention of hemorrhagic episodes in patients with hemophilia B, e.g. congenital factor IX deficiency or Christmas disease, including control and prevention of bleeding in surgical settings.
  • FIG. 1 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 1 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES-IFNa coupling reactions according to example 2.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • FIG. 2 Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 2 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 2. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 3 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 3 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction according to example 3.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions. Load: 10 ⁇ g protein as reaction mixture.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 55 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 4 Cation exchange chromatography of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 4 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction according to example 3. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 5 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 5 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 5.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • FIG. 6 Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 6 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 5. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 7 Peptide Mapping of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa conjugate
  • FIG. 7 shows the chromatographic separation of an IEX-purified oxHES-IFNa conjugate according to example 5 treated with Endo-LysC.
  • the proteolysis was performed using 7.5% Endo-LysC in 50 mM Tris-Cl, pH 8.6, 0.01% SDS at 37° C. o/n.
  • Samples were denatured with DTT and guanidinium chloride and analyzed by RP-HPLC on a 4.6 ⁇ 250 mm Jupiter C4 column (Phenomenex) run with a water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. The chromatograms shown were monitored at 214 nm.
  • the arrow indicates the region of the chromatogram where strong differences between the chromatograms for the protein (A) and the conjugate (13) are visible.
  • the peaks for L 1 and L1/L2 (the N-terminal peptide resulting from the Endo-Lys C treatment) is strongly reduced for the conjugate sample while the other fragments remain virtually unaffected.
  • FIG. 8 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 8 shows the SD S-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 6.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (—35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 70 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 9 Cation exchange chromatography of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 14 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 6. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 10 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 10 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 7.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 11 RP-HPLC analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 11 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 7 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm.
  • the main peak at 11.5 min is the HES protein conjugate separated from free G-CSF eluting at ⁇ 13 min
  • FIG. 12 SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 12 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of a HES-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 10. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • FIG. 13 Anion exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 13 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 10. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 14 SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 14 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 11. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 70 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 15 Cation exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 15 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 11. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 16 SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 16 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES 100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 17 RP-HPLC analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 17 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm.
  • the main peak at 10-10.5 min is the HES protein conjugate separated from free G-CSF eluting at ⁇ 12 min.
  • FIG. 18 Cation exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 18 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIGS. 19-23 are referred to in the context of the respective examples.
  • FIG. 24 shows a section of the HPGPC analysis of an oxHBS-BSA coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.2)” monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 280 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • the upper part shows the BSA starting material prior to the coupling reaction. From left to right, the peaks are at 38.038, 39.277, and 42.272.
  • the lower part shows the HBS-BSA conjugate. From left to right, the peaks are at 36.795, 39.345, and 41.521.
  • FIG. 25 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 25 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.3)”. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • FIG. 26 Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 26 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction according to additional data (A.3) using an ion exchange column. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • Non-reacted, excessive HBS is found in the flowthrough.
  • the HBSylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 27 SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 27 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-EPO coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.4)”. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HBSylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 45 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 28 RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a2) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide
  • FIG. 28 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a2) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 3 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • the main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp 4 )-Kemptide eluting at ⁇ 17 min.
  • FIG. 29 RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a16) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide
  • FIG. 29 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (al 6) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 13 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • the main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp 4 )-Kemptide eluting at ⁇ 17 min.
  • FIG. 30 RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a11) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide
  • FIG. 30 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a11) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 24 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • FIG. 31 RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a12) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide
  • FIG. 31 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a12) and (Trp 4 )-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 30 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
  • the main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp 4 )-Kemptide eluting at ⁇ 17 min
  • FIG. 32 SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reactions
  • FIG. 32 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reactions according to example 18.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MES running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 33 SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-IFNa and HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reactions
  • FIG. 33 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of coupling reactions between HES100/1.0 and rhIFN ⁇ or rhEPO according to example 18.
  • the separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
  • For the electrophoretic separation shown on the right MES buffer was used instead of MOPS.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 19 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein ( ⁇ 35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 60 to >200 kDa.
  • HES aldonic acid was synthesized as described in example 9 of WO 2005/083103 A (in said document, the preparation is described for a hyperbranched starch, HBS) starting from HES with a molecular weight of 55 kDa and a molar substitution of 0.7 (HES55/0.7).
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli ( E. coli ), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • a suitable conjugation buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0
  • oxHES aldehyde A 10fold molar excess of oxHES aldehyde (based on M w ) was used with a protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 6 mg/ml; the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH 3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 1 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0
  • Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
  • the deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon®(Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5).
  • EPO recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon®(Roche)
  • OxHES aldehyde was added at a 10fold molar excess (based on M w ) compared to the EPO concentration.
  • the resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mixture was 5 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 10% (w/v).
  • the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH 3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 0° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 3 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield.
  • Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0
  • Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0.
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate.
  • the conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA.
  • HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • HES aldonic acid was synthesized as described in example 9 of WO 2005/083103 A (in said document, the preparation is described for a hyperbranched starch, HBS) starting from HES with a molecular weight of 100 kDa and a molar substitution of 1.0 (HES100/1.0).
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli ( E. coli ), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • a suitable conjugation buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0
  • oxHES aldehyde A 6fold molar excess of oxHES aldehyde (based on M n ) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 8 mg/ml; the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH 3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 5 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated Interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0
  • Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate.
  • the conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA.
  • HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone ( FIG. 7 ).
  • the deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5).
  • EPO recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)
  • EPO Erypo®
  • OxHES aldehyde was added at a 15fold molar excess (based on M n ) compared to the EPO concentration.
  • the resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mixture was 3.7 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 15% (w/v).
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 8 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0
  • Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0.
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate.
  • the conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA.
  • HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • G-CSF Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor
  • the deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with a rh-Met-G-CSF solution (5 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5; G-CSF expressed by E. coli having the same amino acid sequence and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Neupogen® from Amgen, Ober, D).
  • OxHES aldehyde was added at a 30fold molar excess (based on M n ) compared to the G-CSF concentration.
  • the resulting G-CSF concentration in the reaction mixture was 1.9 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH 3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 0° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 10 ) and reversed phase chromatography ( FIG. 11 ) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the isolation of the product was carried out by lyophilisation.
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli ( E. coli ), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • a suitable conjugation buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0
  • HES aldehyde A 5fold molar excess of HES aldehyde (based on M w ) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 7 mg/ml; the HES aldehyde concentration was 18% (w/v).
  • the deprotected HES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH 3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 12 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated IFNalpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0
  • Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0.
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate.
  • the conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA.
  • HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • the deprotected HES aldehyde from example 9 was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5). HES aldehyde was added at a 40fold molar excess (based on M n ) compared to the EPO concentration. The resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mix was 3.2 mg/ml, the HES aldehyde concentration was 30% (w/v).
  • the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH 3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 14 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0
  • Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0.
  • the deprotected HES aldehyde from example 9 was combined with a rh-Met-G-CSF solution (5 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5; G-CSF expressed by E. coli having the same amino acid sequence and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Neupogen® from Amgen, Ober, D). HES aldehyde was added at a 40fold molar excess (based on M n ) compared to the G-CSF concentration. The resulting G-CSF concentration in the reaction mix was 1.3 mg/ml, the HES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH 3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to determine the conjugation yield. Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 16 ) and reversed phase chromatography ( FIG. 17 ) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield.
  • Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HESylated G-CSF was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0
  • Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0.
  • “Tapvei Einstreu” 4 ⁇ 4 ⁇ 1 mm (wood of Aspen) was used as bedding material for the cages. Additionally wood wool was offered. The cages were changed and cleaned once a week. Drinking water (pH 3.8-4; sulfuric acid) was offered ad libitum. The animal cages were numbered. Within a cage the animals were ear marked and additionally colour coded. On the day of allocation approx. and one week before commencement of treatment, an initial health check has been performed. Only healthy animals were used.
  • HES EPO conjugate as obtained in example 11 the unmodified starting material (rHuEPO) and Aranesp® from Amgen were tested as a single bolus, subcutaneous dose in 4 mice per group at a dosage of 100 ⁇ g/kg body weight, based on the protein content of the samples.
  • One oxHES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugate, prepared according to Example 5 was tested in the in vivo assay according to example 13.
  • the EC50 dilution of the serum samples was half-logarithmically plotted against the time after iv.-injection. Half-life was calculated from the slope of the exponential fit-curve. The half life of the sample was 8.9 hours (see FIG. 20 ).
  • HES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugates prepared according to Example 10 were tested in the in vivo assay according to example 13.
  • the medium of the EC50 dilution of the serum samples was half-logarithmically plotted against the time after iv.-injection.
  • Half-life was calculated from the slope of the exponential fit-curve.
  • the average half life of the samples was 9.7 hours ( FIG. 22 ).
  • test Items After pre-diluting the Test Items in cell culture medium, serial two-fold dilutions were prepared. In 96 well microtiter plates, diluted Interferon was added—in four-fold replicate per dilution- to freshly trypsinized MDBK cells (40.000 cells per well). The assays were incubated for 24 hours at 37° C. (total volume per well: 175 ⁇ l.
  • the assays were incubated for 42 hours at 37° C.
  • the cell culture supernatant of each well was replaced with 50 ⁇ L of a solution of MTT (at least 2 mg/mL in cell culture medium).
  • the cells were incubated for three hours.
  • the purple formazan dye formed by the proliferating cells was solubilized by adding 100 ⁇ L solution of isopropanol/HCl (isopropanol with 40 mM HCl) to each well. Subsequently, the absorbance values of the solutions were measured at 570/630 nm in a microtiter plate reader.
  • the antiviral activity of Interferon-alpha was determined in four separate assays for each of the Test Items.
  • inventive HES-linker derivatives were produced.
  • HES was varied with respect to the mean molecular weight, and with respect to its molar substitution.
  • the chemical nature of the linker was varied, for a given HES starting material.
  • HES HES indicated in the following Tables 1 and 2
  • linker 40 equivalents referred to M n of the HES species
  • the amount of linker was added as a “DMF-linker” solution. Therefore the required amount of linker was dissolved in a small amount of DMF and the resulting clear DMF-linker solution, indicated in Table 2 as “DMF-linker solution V” was added to the reaction mixture.
  • solid NaCNBH 3 indicated as NaCNBH 3 amount was dissolved in the stirred solution to give a final concentration of typically 0.6 M, and the reaction mixture was heated and stirred at 60° C. for 18-24 h.
  • the mixture was diluted by ultrapure water to give a final concentration of about 100 mg/ml (10% m/V) HES derivative and purified either by ultrafiltration (UF) or by dialysis (D) using a membrane with a cut-off of 10 kDa and ultrapure water as solvent.
  • UF ultrafiltration
  • D dialysis
  • the purified HES-derivative solution (10%, 100 mg/ml) was acidified by concentrate HCl solution to give the “c (HCl)” with the appropriate “pH level”.
  • the mixture was stirred and heated at 40° C. for the reaction time “t” and afterwards neutralized (dil. NaOH), worked up by ultrafiltration (membrane cut-off 10 kDa) using the appropriate “work up solvent” and finally lyophilized to give a white to yellowish powder.
  • the derivatization was verified by successfully coupling to a target molecule (Kemptide, see the following example 18, Tables 3, 4, and 5).
  • a target molecule Kemptide, see the following example 18, Tables 3, 4, and 5.
  • the successful derivatization was checked by spectral properties. All HES-derivatives, prepared as described above were used for the conjugation to the targets, listed in example 18 in Tables 3, 4, and 5.
  • Linker structure (a2) relates to the structure (a2) as defined hereinabove, i.e. to 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane,
  • the amount of the target molecule as indicated in the following Tables 3, 4, and 5 was transferred into the appropriate reaction buffer.
  • the indicated amount of the HES-linker derivative (defined by the linker and the HES species) was dissolved in reaction buffer and mixed with the target substance solution.
  • NaCNBH 3 typically as a freshly prepared 0.5 M stock solution in reaction buffer—was added to a final concentration of typically 20 mM.
  • the reaction mixture was incubated under temperature control at the temperature “rxn T” for the reaction time “rxn t”.
  • HES HES target target amount HES HES % linker species molecule buffer system amount [mg] target (w/v) (a2) 100/1.0 rhIFN ⁇ 0.1M NaOAc, pH 4 3 mg 76 5:1 18 (M w ) (a2) 100/1.0 rhFIX 0.1M HEPES, pH 7 3.5 mg 133 29:1 25 (a2) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 40 ⁇ g 2.6 50:1 16 (a2) 100/1.0 rhGH 0.1M Citrate, pH 6 0.1 mg 16 60:1 40 (a2) 100/1.0 mIgG 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 3 80:1 3 (a2) 100/1.0 hFab 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 50 ⁇ g 3.8 60:1 20 (a2) 100/1.0 GLP-1 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 30 ⁇ g 26 60:1 20 (a2) 100/1.0 GLP-1 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5
  • HES HES HES linker species target buffer system target [mg] target 1 (a1) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 ⁇ g 12.3 5.6:1 2 (a3) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 0.1 mg 10.4 40:1 3 (a4) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 ⁇ g 12.1 5.6:1 4 (a4) 100/1.0 rhIFN ⁇ 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 0.1 mg 2.7 8:1 5 (a4) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 100 ⁇ g 4.3 20:1 6 (a4) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 53 ⁇ g 5.2 30:1 7 (a4) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 22.5 60:1 8 (a4) 100/1.0 NH 2 -DNA 0.05M H
  • NaCNBH 3 rxn V rxn T rxn t linker species target HES % [g/l] [mM] [ ⁇ l] [° C.] [h] 1 (a1) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.49 20 61 5 18 2 (a3) 100/1.0 rhEPO 30 2.9 20 35 10 18 3 (a4) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18 4 (a4) 100/1.0 rhIFN ⁇ 20 7.5 20 13 5 18 5 (a4) 100/1.0 rhEPO 20 4.7 20 21 5 18 6 (a4) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 15 1.5 20 35 10 18 7 (a4) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 25 1.1 20 90 5 18 8 (a4) 100/1.0 NH 2 -DNA 20 0.4 20 16 30 18 9 (a4) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 7 1.1 20 39 10 18 10 (a4) 100/1.0 hFab 20 2.7 20 19 5 18 11 (a4) 100/1.0 rhGH 40
  • the aldonic acid obtained was transferred into the corresponding lactone by drying for 24 h at 80° C. (the abbreviation “oxHBS” refers to the HBS aldonic acid as well as to the corresponding lactone).
  • the retentate was treated with 2 g of an acidic cation exchange resign (Amberlite® 120) for 2 h, the resign was filtered off and the remaining solution lyophilized.
  • an acidic cation exchange resign Amberlite® 120
  • the 1 H-NMR Spectrum of the compound showed a triplett at 1.7 and a multiplett at 1.2 ppm representing the methyl- and the methylene groups in alpha-position to the nitrogen atom of the residue of the linker compound (1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane).
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli ( E. coli ), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • a suitable conjugation buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0
  • oxHBS aldehyde A 10fold molar excess of oxHBS aldehyde (based on M w ) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 6 mg/ml; the oxHBS aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the deprotected oxHBS aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and to the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH 3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 25 ) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • the HBS-Interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an ⁇ kta system (GE Healthcare).
  • Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0
  • Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
  • the deprotected oxHBS aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5).
  • OxHBS aldehyde was added at a 20fold molar excess (based on M w ) compared to the EPO concentration.
  • the resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mix was 4.6 mg/ml, the oxHBS aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v).
  • the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH 3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE ( FIG. 27 ) and reversed phase chromatography (FIG. A.4-1) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Polymers & Plastics (AREA)
  • Materials Engineering (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Physical Education & Sports Medicine (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Orthopedic Medicine & Surgery (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Inorganic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Polysaccharides And Polysaccharide Derivatives (AREA)
  • Medicinal Preparation (AREA)

Abstract

The invention relates to a method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative which comprises reacting hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) via the optionally oxidised reducing end of the HAS with the amino group M of a crosslinking compound which, apart from the amino group, comprises a specifically protected carbonyl group, namely an acetal group or a ketal group.

Description

  • The invention relates to a method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative which comprises reacting hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) via the optionally oxidised reducing end of the HAS with the amino group M of a crosslinking compound which, apart from the amino group, comprises a specifically protected carbonyl group, namely an acetal group or a ketal group. The method may further comprise a reaction of the HAS derivative thus obtained with the amino group of a biologically active compound via alkylation, preferably via reductive amination. Moreover, the invention relates to the HAS derivatives obtainable or obtained by the inventive process and to specific HAS derivatives as such. The invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising the HAS derivatives containing the biologically active compound, these HAS derivates as therapeutic or prophylactic agent and the use of specific HAS derivatives for the preparation of medicaments.
  • Hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS), in particular hydroxyethyl starch (HES), is a substituted derivative of naturally occurring carbohydrate polymer amylopectin, which is present in corn starch at a concentration of up to 95% by weight, and is degraded by alpha-amylase in the body. HES, in particular, exhibits advantageous biological properties and is used as a blood volume replacement agent and in hemodilution therapy in the clinics (Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Krankenhauspharmazie, 8(8), 271-278; Weidler et al., 1991, Arzneimittel-forschung/Drug Res., 41, 494-498).
  • Some ways of producing a hydroxyethyl starch derivative are described in the art.
  • DE 26 16 086 discloses the conjugation of hemoglobin to hydroxyethyl starch wherein, in a first step, a cross-linking agent, e.g. bromocyane, is bound to hydroxyethyl starch and subsequently hemoglobin is linked to the intermediate product.
  • One important field in which HES is used is the stabilization of polypeptides which are applied, e.g., to the circulatory system in order to obtain a particular physiological effect. One specific example of these polypeptides is erythropoietin, an acid glycoprotein of approximately 34,000 kDa which is essential in regulating the level of red blood cells in the circulation.
  • A well-known problem with the application of polypeptides and enzymes is that these proteins often exhibit an unsatisfactory stability. Especially erythropoietin has a relatively short plasma half live (Spivak and Hogans, 1989, Blood 73, 90; McMahon et al., 1990, Blood 76, 1718). This means that therapeutic plasma levels are rapidly lost and repeated intravenous administrations must be carried out. Furthermore, in certain circumstances an immune response against the peptides is observed.
  • It is generally accepted that the stability of polypeptides can be improved and the immune response against these polypeptides is reduced when the polypeptides are coupled to polymeric molecules.
  • WO 94/28024 discloses that physiologically active polypeptides modified with polyethylene glycol (PEG) exhibit reduced immunogenicity and antigenicity and circulate in the bloodstream considerably longer than unconjugated proteins, i.e. have a longer clearance rate. However, PEG-drug conjugates exhibit several disadvantages, e.g. they do not exhibit a natural structure which can be recognized by elements of in vivo degradation pathways. Therefore, apart from PEG-conjugates, other conjugates and protein polymerates have been produced.
  • WO 02/080979 discloses compounds comprising a conjugate of an active agent and a hydroxyalkyl starch wherein active agent and hydroxyalkyl starch are either linked directly or via a linker compound. As far as the direct linkage is concerned, the reaction of active agent and hydroxyalkyl starch is carried out in an aqueous medium which comprises at least 10 wt.-% of water. No examples are given which are directed to a hydroxyalkyl starch linked to crosslinking compound via an amino group of said crosslinking compound wherein the crosslinking compound further contains a protected carbonyl group. Additionally, no examples are given showing a HAS derivative which is obtained by reacting said HAS derivative via said carbonyl group with an amino group of a biologically active agent.
  • WO 03/074087 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch protein conjugates in which the bonding between a hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and a protein is covalent and is the result of a coupling of a terminal aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or a functional group which resulted from the reaction of said aldehyde group with a functional group of a protein.
  • WO 03/074088 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch conjugates with a low molecular weight compound in which the bonding between the hydroxyalkyl starch and the low molecular weight compound is covalent and is the result of a coupling of a terminal aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or a functional group which resulted from the reaction of said aldehyde group with a functional group of a protein.
  • WO 2005/014024 discloses polymers functionalized by an aminooxy group or a derivative thereof, conjugates, wherein the functionalized polymers are covalently coupled with a protein by an oxime linking group, a process for preparing the functionalized polymers, a process for preparing the conjugates, functionalized polymers as obtainable by the process of the present invention, conjugates as obtainable by the process, and pharmaceutical compositions comprising at least one conjugate and the use of said conjugates and compositions for the prophylaxis or therapy of the human or animal body.
  • WO 2005/092390 discloses conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein wherein these conjugates are formed by a covalent linkage between the hydroxyalkyl starch or a derivative of the hydroxyalkyl starch and the protein and a method of producing these conjugates and the use of these conjugates.
  • WO 2004/024777 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivates, particularly hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process in which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a linker compound. According to an especially preferred embodiment, WO 2004/024777 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process according to which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a linker compound and the resulting reaction product is reacted with a polypeptide, preferably with a glycoprotein and especially preferably with erythropoietin, via at least one other reactive group of the linker compound. A hydroxyalkyl starch which is especially preferred is hydroxyethyl starch. According to WO 2004/024777, the hydroxyalkyl starch and preferably the hydroxylethyl starch is reacted with the linker compound at its reducing end which is not oxidised prior to the reaction.
  • WO 2004/024776 discloses hydroxyalkyl starch derivates, particularly hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process in which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a crosslinking compound or with two crosslinking compounds wherein the resulting hydroxyalkyl starch derivative has at least one functional group X which is capable of being reacted with a functional group Y of a further compound and wherein this group Y of the further compound is an aldehyde group, a keto group, a hemiacetal group, an acetal group, or a thio group. According to an especially preferred embodiment, WO 2004/024776 relates to hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives obtainable by a process according to which hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a primary or secondary amino group of a crosslinking compound, the resulting reaction product optionally being further reacted with a second crosslinking compound, wherein the resulting hydroxyalkyl starch derivative has at least one functional group X which is capable of being reacted with a functional group Y of a further compound and wherein this group Y is an aldehyde group, a keto group, a hemiacetal group, an acetal group, or a thio group, and the resulting reaction product is reacted with a polypeptide, preferably with a polypeptide such as AT III, IFN-beta or erythropoietin and especially preferably with erythropoietin, which comprises at least one of these functional groups Y. A hydroxyalkyl starch which is especially preferred is hydroxyethyl starch. According to WO 2004/024776 the hydroxyalkyl starch and preferably the hydroxyethyl starch is reacted with the linker compound at its reducing end which is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction.
  • WO 2005/092928 discloses conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch, preferably hydroxyethyl starch, and a protein, wherein these conjugates are formed by a reductive amination reaction between at least one aldehyde group of the hydroxyalkyl starch or of a derivative of the hydroxyalkyl starch, and at least one amino group of the protein, so that the hydroxyalkyl starch or the derivative thereof is covalently linked to the protein via an azomethine linkage or an aminomethylene linkage. WO 2005/092928 also relates to a method of producing these conjugates and specific uses of the conjugates.
  • US 2006/0194940 A1 discloses water-soluble polymer alkanals. Among others, protected aldehyde reagents are disclosed which are reacted with a polymer. While poly(saccharides) are generically mentioned, especially preferred polymers are polyethylene glycols. Starches or, in particular, modified starches such as hydroxyalkyl starches are not disclosed in US 2006/0194940 A1. Consequently, US 2006/0194940 A1 contains no disclosures concerning specific ways of coupling a given linker compound to hydroxyalkyl starch. The same applies to U.S. Pat. No. 7,157,546 B2, EP 1 591 467 A1 and WO 2004/022630 A2.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2 discloses an aminoacetal crosslinking compound in unprotected and protected form. No disclosure is contained in this document relating to a possible coupling of this crosslinking compound with polymers other than polyethylene glycols. In particular, starches, let alone modified starches such as hydroxyalkyl starches are not disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2. Consequently, U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2 contains no disclosures concerning specific ways of coupling a given linker compound to hydroxyalkyl starch. The same applies to U.S. Pat. No. 6,956,135 B2 and WO 03/049699 A2.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 5,990,237 discloses structures containing a protected aldehyde group. Compounds comprising these structures are preferably coupled to polyethylene glycol, and coupling is carried out via a halide as functional group comprised in the protected aldehyde group containing compounds, which halide group reacts with a hydroxy group of the polyethylene glycol.
  • It is an object of the present invention to provide a novel method to obtain hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives.
  • It is a further object of the present invention to provide novel HAS derivatives such as HAS derivatives obtained or obtainable by reacting HAS with specifically functionalized crosslinking compounds.
  • It is yet another object of the present invention to provide further novel HAS derivatives such as HAS derivatives obtained or obtainable by reacting the HAS derivatives—obtained or obtainable by reacting HAS with specifically functionalized crosslinking compounds—with a suitable functional group of biologically active compound.
  • Surprisingly, it was found that it is possible to use, for the preparation of specific HAS derivatives, a crosslinking compound which, on the one hand, can selectively be coupled to the optionally oxidized reducing end of a hydroxyalkyl starch via an amino group and, on the other hand, has—as a second functional group—a fully protected carbonyl group, namely an acetal group or a ketal group. Compared to embodiments where a crosslinking compound is employed having a free aldehyde or keto group or, e.g., a hemiacetal group as functional group, employing such a fully protected group drastically minimises the risk that, during reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound, undesired oligomerisation or polymerisation between the crosslinking compound molecules takes places. Unexpectedly, it was found that deprotection of the acetal or ketal group comprised in the resulting HAS derivative is possible without at least partially destroying the specific chemical structure of the hydroxyalkyl starch, in particular the hydroxyethyl starch, being characterised by numerous functional groups such as acetal groups and ether groups. Therefore, the present invention allows for an extremely effective method of preparing a first HAS derivative by minimising the risk of oliogomerisation or polymerisation between the individual crosslinking compound molecules, combined with the possibility of deprotecting the functional groups of the resulting HAS derivatives without at least partial destruction of the HAS structure, in order to provide a HAS derivative allowing for an effective coupling with a biologically active compound.
  • Thus, the present invention relates to a method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative, comprising
  • (i) reacting hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00001
      • via carbon atom C* of the reducing end of the HAS with the amino group M of a crosslinking compound according to formula (II)

  • M-L-A
      • wherein A is an acetal group or a ketal group; and L is a spacer bridging M and A,
      • wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M,
      • obtaining a HAS derivative according to formula (III)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00002
      • wherein X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of the amino group M to with the HAS via carbon atom C* of the optionally oxidised reducing end of the HAS, and
      • wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule, and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
  • Further, the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative obtainable or obtained by this method.
  • Moreover, the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative of formula (III)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00003
  • wherein A is an acetal or ketal group; L is a spacer bridging X and A;
    wherein X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of an amino group M of a crosslinking compound of formula (II)

  • M-L-A
  • with hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00004
  • via carbon atom C* of the HAS, wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M,
    wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
  • Hydroxyalkyl Starch
  • In the context of the present invention, the term “hydroxyalkyl starch” (HAS) refers to a starch derivative which has been substituted by at least one hydroxyalkyl group. A preferred hydroxyalkyl starch of the present invention has a constitution according to formula (I′)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00005
  • wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen, a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group or the group

  • —[(CR1R2)mO]n[CR3R4]o—OH
  • wherein R1, R2, R3, and R4 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, and alkyl group, preferably hydrogen and methyl group,
    m is 2 to 4, wherein the residues R1 and R2 may be the same or different in the m groups CR1R2;
    n is 0 to 20, preferably 0 to 4;
    o is 2 to 20, preferably 2 to 4, wherein the residues R3 and R4 may be the same or different in the o groups CR3R4.
  • Preferably, R1, R2 and R3 are independently a group —(CH2CH2O)n—H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6, and in particular, R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or 2-hydroxyethyl.
  • In formula (I) and (I′) the reducing end of the starch molecule is shown in the non-oxidised form and the terminal saccharide unit of HAS is shown in the hemiacetal form which, depending on e.g. the solvent, may be in equilibrium with the (free) aldehyde form. The abbreviation HAS′ as used in the context of the present invention refers to the HAS molecule without the terminal saccharide unit at the reducing end of the HAS molecule. This is meant by the term “remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule” as used in the context of the present invention.
  • The term “hydroxyalkyl starch” as used in the present invention is not limited to compounds where the terminal carbohydrate moiety comprises hydroxyalkyl groups R1, R2 and/or R3 as depicted, for the sake of brevity, in formulas (I) and (I′), but also refers to compounds in which at least one hydroxy group which is present anywhere, either in the terminal carbohydrate moiety and/or in the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule, HAS′, is substituted by a hydroxyalkyl group R1, R2 and/or R3.
  • Hydroxyalkyl starch comprising two or more different hydroxyalkyl groups is also possible.
  • The at least one hydroxyalkyl group comprised in HAS may contain one or more, in particular two or more hydroxy groups. According to a preferred embodiment, the at least one hydroxyalkyl group comprised in HAS contains one hydroxy group.
  • The expression “hydroxyalkyl starch” also includes derivatives wherein the alkyl group is mono- or polysubstituted. In this context, it is preferred that the alkyl group is substituted with a halogen, especially fluorine, or with an aryl group. Furthermore, the hydroxy group of a hydroxyalkyl group may be esterified or etherified.
  • Furthermore, instead of alkyl, also linear or branched substituted or unsubstituted alkenyl groups may be used.
  • Hydroxyalkyl starch is an ether derivative of starch. Besides of said ether derivatives, also other starch derivatives can be used in the context of the present invention. For example, derivatives are useful which comprise esterified hydroxy groups. These derivatives may be e.g. derivatives of unsubstituted mono- or dicarboxylic acids with 2-12 carbon atoms or of substituted derivatives thereof. Especially useful are derivatives of unsubstituted monocarboxylic acids with 2-6 carbon atoms, especially derivatives of acetic acid. In this context, acetyl starch, butyryl starch and propionyl starch are preferred.
  • Furthermore, derivatives of unsubstituted dicarboxylic acids with 2-6 carbon atoms are preferred.
  • In the case of derivatives of dicarboxylic acids, it is useful that the second carboxy group of the dicarboxylic acid is also esterified. Furthermore, derivatives of monoalkyl esters of dicarboxylic acids are also suitable in the context of the present invention.
  • For the substituted mono- or dicarboxylic acids, the substitute groups may be preferably the same as mentioned above for substituted alkyl residues.
  • Techniques for the esterification of starch are known in the art (see e.g. Klemm D. et al, Comprehensive Cellulose Chemistry Vol. 2, 1998, Whiley-VCH, Weinheim, N.Y., especially chapter 4.4, Esterification of Cellulose (ISBN 3-527-29489-9).
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, hydroxyalkyl starch according to above-mentioned formula (I) is employed. The other saccharide ring structures comprised in HAS′ may be the same as or different from the explicitly described saccharide ring, with the difference that they lack a reducing end.
  • As far as the residues R1, R2 and R3 according to formula (I) are concerned there are no specific limitations. According to a preferred embodiment, R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a hydroxyalkyl group, a hydroxyaralkyl group or a hydroxyalkaryl group having of from 2 to 10 carbon atoms in the respective alkyl residue. Hydrogen and hydroxyalkyl groups having of from 2 to 10 carbon atoms are preferred. More preferably, the hydroxyalkyl group has from 2 to 6 carbon atoms, more preferably from 2 to 4 carbon atoms, and even more preferably from 2 to 3 carbon atoms. In a preferred embodiment, hydroxyalkyl starch is hydroxyethyl starch in which R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a group (CH2CH2O)n—H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • “Hydroxyalkyl starch” therefore preferably comprises hydroxyethyl starch, hydroxypropyl starch and hydroxybutyl starch, wherein hydroxyethyl starch and hydroxypropyl starch are particularly preferred and hydroxyethyl starch is most preferred.
  • The alkyl, aralkyl and/or alkaryl group may be linear or branched and suitably substituted.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method and a HAS derivative as described above wherein R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group with from 2 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • Thus, R1, R2 and R3 preferably may be H, hydroxyhexyl, hydroxypentyl, hydroxybutyl, hydroxypropyl such as 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyisopropyl, hydroxyethyl such as 2-hydroxyethyl, hydrogen and the 2-hydroxyethyl group being especially preferred.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method and a HAS derivative as described above wherein R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a 2-hydroxyethyl group, an embodiment wherein at least one residue R1, R2 and R3 being 2-hydroxyethyl being especially preferred.
  • Hydroxyethyl starch (HES) is most preferred for all embodiments of the present invention.
  • Therefore, the present invention relates to the method and a HAS derivative as described above, wherein the polymer is hydroxyethyl starch and the derivative is a hydroxyethyl starch (HES) derivative.
  • HAS, in particular HES, is mainly characterized by the molecular weight distribution, the degree of substitution and the ratio of C2:C6 substitution. There are two possibilities of describing the substitution degree:
  • The degree of substitution (DS) of HAS is described relatively to the portion of substituted glucose monomers with respect to all glucose moieties.
  • The substitution pattern of HAS can also be described as the molar substitution (MS), wherein the number of hydroxyethyl groups per glucose moiety is counted.
  • In the context of the present invention, the substitution pattern of HAS, preferably HES, is referred to as MS, as described above (see also Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Krankenhauspharmazie, 8(8), 271-278, in particular p. 273).
  • MS is determined by Gas Chromatography after total hydrolysis of the HES molecule. MS values of respective HAS, in particular HES starting material are given. It is assumed that the MS value is not affected during the derivatization procedure in steps a) and b) of the process of the invention.
  • HAS and in particular HES solutions are present as polydisperse compositions, wherein each molecule differs from the other with respect to the polymerization degree, the number and pattern of branching sites, and the substitution pattern. HAS and in particular HES is therefore a mixture of compounds with different molecular weight. Consequently, a particular HAS and in particular HES solution is determined by average molecular weight with the help of statistical means. In this context, Mn is calculated as the arithmetic mean depending on the number of molecules. Alternatively, Mw (or MW), the weight average molecular weight, represents a unit which depends on the mass of the HAS, in particular HES.
  • In this context the number average molecular weight is defined by equation 1:
  • M _ n = i n i · M i i n i
  • where ni is the number of molecules of species i of molar mass Mi.
  • M n indicates that the value is an average, but the line is normally omitted by convention.
  • Mw is the weight average molecular weight, defined by equation 2:
  • M _ w = i n i · M i 2 i n i M i
  • where ni is the number of molecules of species i of molar mass Mi
  • M w indicates that the value is an average, but the line is normally omitted by convention.
  • Preferably, the hydroxyalkyl starch, in particular the hydroxyethyl starch, used in the invention has a mean molecular weight (weight mean) of from 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa. Hydroxyethyl starch can further exhibit a preferred molar substitution of from 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.1 to 2, more preferred 0.1 to 0.9 or 0.4 to 2, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, and a preferred ratio between C2:C6 substitution in the range of from 2 to 20 with respect to the hydroxyethyl groups.
  • The term “mean molecular weight” as used in the context of the present invention relates to the weight as determined according to the LALLS-(low angle laser light scattering)-GPC method as described in Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Krankenhauspharmazie, 8(8), 271-278; and Weidler et al., 1991, Arzneim.-Forschung/Drug Res., 41, 494-498. For mean molecular weights of 10 kDa and smaller, additionally, the calibration was carried out with a standard which had previously been qualified by LALLS-GPC.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, the mean molecular weight of hydroxyethyl starch employed is from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa.
  • Further, the molar substitution of HAS and in particular HES is preferably from about 0.1 to about 3, preferably about 0.4 to about 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3.
  • An example of HES having a mean molecular weight of about 5 to 300 kDa, preferably 50 to 150 kDa is a HES with a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3.
  • As far as the ratio of C2:C6 substitution is concerned, said substitution is preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • Other Starches than Hydroxyalkyl Starches
  • In general, the methods of the present invention can also be carried out, and the derivatives of the present invention can also be prepared using other starches than hydroxyalkyl starches, in particular hydroxyethyl starch as described above, with the proviso that these starches also contain a reducing end being present in the hemiacetal form, optionally in equilibrium with the (free) aldehyde from, which reducing end may suitably be oxidised to give the respective oxidised form. In particular, a highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be employed, i.e. a starch which has a significantly higher degree of branching than amylopectin and has the degree of alpha-1,6 branching of glycogen, or even exceeds this, and, if substituted, has a molar substitution MS of only up to 0.3, preferably of from 0.05 to 0.3. The term MS (molar substitution) as used in the context of this highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product means the average number of hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups per anhydroglucose unit. The MS is normally measured by determining the content of hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups in a sample and computational allocation to the anhydroglucose units present therein. The MS can also be determined by gas chromatography. The degree of branching can be determined by a gas chromatographic methylation analysis as mol-% of the alpha-1,4,6-glycosidically linked anhydroglucoses in the polymer. The degree of branching is in every case an average because the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product of the invention is a polydisperse compound. The glucose units in said highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product are linked via alpha-1,4- and alpha-1,6-linkages. The degree of branching means the proportion of alpha-1,4,6-linked glucose units in mol % of the totality of all anhydroglucoses. The C2/C6 ratio expresses the ratio or substitution at C-2 to that at C-6. The highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product has a preferred degree of branching of from 6% to 50%, achievable by a transglucosidation step with the aid of branching enzymes. Even more preferably, the degree of branching is in the range of from 10 to 45, more preferably from 20 to 40 such as 20, 25, 30, 35, or 40. Also preferred are ranges of from more than 20 to 40, preferably from more than 20 to 30 such as from 21 to 40, preferably from 21 to 30. The starting material which can be used for this purpose is in principle any starch, but preferably waxy starches with a high proportion of amylopectin or the amylopectin fraction itself. The degree of branching which is necessary for the use according to the present invention of the starch products—as far as these “other starches” are concerned—is in the range from 8% to 20%, expressed as mol % of anhydroglucoses. This means that the starch products which can be used for the purposes of the invention have on average one alpha-1,6 linkage, and thus a branching point, every 12.5 to 5 glucose units. Preferred highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products have a degree of branching of more than 10% and up to 20% and in particular from 11 to 18%. A higher degree of branching means a greater solubility of the starch products of the invention and a greater bioavailability of these dissolved starch products in the body. Particular preference is given to unmodified starch products with a degree of branching of more than 10%, in particular from 11% to 18%. The highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be prepared by targeted enzymatic assembly using so-called branching or transfer enzymes, where appropriate followed by partial derivatisation of free hydroxyl groups with hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl groups. Instead of this it is possible to convert a hydroxyethylated or hydroxypropylated starch by enzymatic assembly using so-called branching or transfer enzymes into a highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product. Obtaining branched starch products enzymatically from wheat starch with a degree of branching of up to 10% is known per se and described for example in WO 00/66633 A. Suitable branching or transfer enzymes and the obtaining thereof are disclosed in WO 00/18893 A, U.S. Pat. No. 4,454,161, EP 0 418 945 A, JP 2001294601 A or US 2002/065410 A. This latter publication describes unmodified starch products with degrees of branching of more than 4% and up to 10% or higher. The enzymatic transglycosilation can be carried out in a manner known per se, for example by incubating waxy corn starch, potato starch obtained from potatoes having a high amylopectin content, or starch obtained from rice, from manioc, from wheat, from wheat having a high amylopectin content, from corn, from corn having a high amolypectin content, or from corn having a high amylose content, with the appropriate enzymes under mild conditions at pH values between 6 and 8 and temperatures between 25 and 40° C. in aqueous solution. The molecular weight Mw means, as used in the context of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products, the weight average molecular weight. This can be determined in a manner known per se by various methods, i.e. by gel permeation chromatography (GPC) or high pressure liquid chromatography (HPLC) in conjunction with light scattering and RI detection. The C2/C6 ratio preferred for substituted starches is in the range from 5 to 9. The high degree of branching of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch products increases the solubility in water thereof to such an extent that hydroxyethyl or hydroxypropyl substitution can be wholly or substantially dispensed with in order to keep the starch product in solution. The average molecular weight of the highly branched, unsubstituted or low-substituted starch product can be increased in a suitable manner via the permeability limit of the peritoneum. The characteristic variable which can be used in this case is also the GPC value of the so-called bottom fraction BF90% (molecular weight at 90% of the peak area as a measure of the proportion of smaller molecule fractions). A greater ultrafiltration (UF) efficiency can be achieved by appropriate raising of the molecular weight with, at the same time, a drastically reduced absorption across the peritoneal membrane. At the same time, high molecular weight residual fragments which are produced by degradation by endogenous amylase, which can no longer be further degraded by amylase, and which are stored in organs or tissues, no longer occur or now occur to only a slight extent.
  • According to the present invention, hydroxyalkyl starch is reacted with a crosslinking compound M-L-A wherein M is an amino group and A is an acetal group or a ketal group, group M and group L being separated by a suitable spacer.
  • The Acetal or Ketal Group A
  • As far as the acetal group or ketal group A is concerned, no specific limitations exist. In the context of the present invention, the term “acetal group” also comprises sulphur acetals and nitrogen acetals, and the term “ketal group” also comprises sulphur ketals and nitrogen ketals. Additionally, as far as the term “acetal group” is concerned, hemiacetals are explicitly excluded, and as far as the term “ketal group” is concerned, hemiketals are explicitly excluded.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, group A of the crosslinking compound M-L-A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00006
  • wherein
    Z1 and Z2 are each independently O or S or NRx, preferably O, wherein Rx, is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl such as n-propyl or i-propyl, or C(O)—Ry wherein Ry is preferably selected from the group consisting of C1-C6 alkyl and C6-C14 aryl, even more preferably selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl; Rx preferably being H;
    A1 and A2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzyl, methoxybenzyl, ethoxybenzyl, or are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00007
  • wherein A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2— or —(CH2)3— or —(CH2CH(CH3))—, and wherein A3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L.
  • Preferably, at least one of Z1 and Z2 is O, more preferably both Z1 and Z2 are O.
  • As far as the residue A3 is concerned, acetal groups are preferred according to the present invention, i.e. A3 is preferably H.
  • If A is a ketal group, it is preferred that A3 is methyl. Therefore, conceivable ketal groups A according to the present invention are, among others,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00008
  • If A3 is, e.g., forming a ring with either the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, conceivable crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are, e.g.,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00009
  • An especially preferred crosslinking compound according to the present invention is
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00010
  • i.e., the amino group M is a secondary amine, both Z1 and Z2 are O, and A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2—.
  • According to a preferred embodiment, A1 and A2 are each methyl or ethyl, even more preferably ethyl. Therefore, a particularly preferred acetal group A according to the present invention is —CH(OCH3)2 or —CH(OC2H5)2, in particular —CH(OC2H5)2.
  • According to a further embodiment wherein A1 and A2 are forming a ring according to formula (IIb), A1 and A2, taken together, are preferably —(CH2)2—. As far as this embodiment is concerned, particularly preferred acetal groups A according to the present invention are
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00011
  • The Amino Group M
  • As far as the amino group M is concerned, no particular restrictions exist with the proviso that the amino group can be reacted with either the oxidised or non-oxidised reducing end, i.e. via carbon atom C* of the reducing terminal saccharide unit of HAS, preferably HES, in either the non-oxidised state, i.e. as hemiacetal or as free aldehyde group, or in the oxidised state, i.e. as lactone or as free carboxy group. The term “amino group” as used in this context of the present application also comprises suitable salts of the amino group, such as, e.g., protonated amino groups, with a pharmaceutically acceptable anion, such as, e.g., chloride, hydrogen sulfate, sulfate, carbonate, hydrogen carbonate, citrate, phosphate, or hydrogen phosphate.
  • Preferably, the amino group of the crosslinking compound M-L-A according to the present invention is a group according to formula (IIc)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00012
  • wherein Y is either absent or is a chemical moiety selected from the group consisting of
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00013
  • wherein G is O or S or NH, and, if present twice, each G is independently O or S or NH, G preferably being O, and
    wherein R′ is H or a hydroxy group or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, and substituted alkylaryl. In this context, the term “alkyl” relates to non-branched alkyl residues, branched alkyl residues, and cycloalkyl residues. Preferably, each of these organic residues has from 1 to 10 carbon atoms. As conceivable substituents, halogens such as F, Cl or Br may be mentioned. Preferably, the organic residues are non-substituted hydrocarbons.
  • If R′ is a hydroxy group, the preferred amino group of the present invention is HO—NH—, i.e. Y is absent.
  • Preferably, in case R′ is an organic residue, R′ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl, the alkyl residue being especially preferred. Even more preferably, the optionally substituted alkyl residue has from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4 such as 1, 2, 3, or 4 carbon atoms. Thus, preferred organic residues according to the present invention are methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, or t-butyl. According to an especially preferred embodiment, the organic residue R′ is methyl or ethyl, in particular methyl.
  • Therefore, in case R′ is an organic residue, preferred amino groups according to the present invention are, e.g., H3C—CH2—NH—, H3C—NH—, H5C6—NH—, H3C—CH2—NH—O—, H3C—NH—O—, H5C6—NH—O—, with H3C—NH—, H5C6—NH—, and H3C—NH—O— being particularly preferred.
  • According to the present invention, it is also possible that R′ is not a separate residue but forms a ring structure with a suitable atom comprised in L or with residue A3 of group A of the crosslinking compound. These structures are also comprised in above-mentioned definition of the term “alkyl” with respect to R′. By way of example, R′ can form a ring structure with residue A3 of group A of the crosslinking compound, A being a ketal group. Conceivable crosslinking compounds are, e.g.,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00014
  • In this case, an especially preferred crosslinking compound according to the present invention is
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00015
  • i.e., the amino group M is a secondary amine, both Z1 and Z2 are O, and A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2—.
  • In a preferred embodiment of the present invention, R′ is H. Thus, preferred amino groups M of the present are
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00016
  • wherein G is O or S, and, if present twice, independently O or S, O being preferred.
  • Especially preferred amino groups M of the present invention, if R′ is H, are H2N—, H2N—O—, and H2N—NH—(C═O)—.
  • Hence, the present invention also relates to the method and the derivative mentioned above, wherein the amino group M is H2N—, H2N—O—, H2N—NH—(C═O)—, H3C—NH— or H3C—NH—O—, preferably H2N—, H2N—O—, or H2N—NH—(C═O)—.
  • The Spacer L
  • According to the present invention, functional groups M and A of the crosslinking compound are separated by a suitable spacer. The term “spacer” as used in this context of the present application relates to any suitable chemical moiety bridging M and A.
  • In general, there are no particular restrictions as to the chemical nature of the spacer L with the proviso that L has in particular chemical properties enabling carrying out the inventive method for the preparation of the novel derivatives and providing suitable chemical properties for the novel derivatives as far as their intended use is concerned.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, L bridging M and A is a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00017
  • wherein L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R″ wherein R″ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl.
  • In this context, the term “alkyl” relates to non-branched alkyl residues, branched alkyl residues, and cycloalkyl residues. As preferred substituents, halogens such as F, Cl or Br may be mentioned.
  • Preferably, L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably, L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or alkyl; even more preferably, both L1 and L2 are H.
  • Preferably, if L1 and L2 are organic residues, each of L1 and L2 may independently contain 1 to 20, preferably 1 to 10, more preferably 1 to 8, more preferably 1 to 6, more preferably 1 to 4 carbon atoms. Especially preferred are residues L1 and L2 such as optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, tert-butyl residues. According to the present invention, L1 may be H and L2 may be an organic residue as defined above.
  • As far as integer n is concerned, n is preferably from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • If integer n is greater than 1, the groups (CL1L2) may be the same or different from each other. According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, groups (CL1L2) directly linked to each other have the same constitution.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, the spacer L consists of a structural unit according to formula (IId) wherein L1 and L2 are as defined above. More preferably, integer n is from 1 to 20, more preferably from 1 to 10 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10. Even more preferably, each of the groups (CL1L2) is (CH2) such that spacer L bridging M and A has the structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00018
  • wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, more preferably from 1 to 10 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 10. Even more preferably, n is in the range of from 1 to 6, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 4, such as 1, 2, 3, or 4, and in particular 2.
  • Therefore, according to a particularly preferred embodiment of the present invention, spacer L is —CH2—CH2—.
  • According to further embodiments of the present invention, spacer L of the crosslinking compound comprises at least one structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00019
  • wherein n, L1 and L2 are as defined above, preferably
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00020
  • and wherein L further comprises at least one chemical moiety different from —(CL1L2)—.
  • In this context, embodiments may be mentioned wherein the spacer L consists of a structural unit —(CL1L2)n- and a further chemical moiety T which separates —(CL1L2)n- from group M or A. Also embodiments are conceivable wherein the spacer L consists of a structural unit —(CL1L2)n- and two further chemical moieties T1 and T2 wherein T1 separates —(CL1L2)n- from group M and T2 separates —(CL1L2)n- from group A. Thus, the present invention also encompasses embodiments according to which the crosslinking compound has one of the following structures:

  • M-T-(CL1L2)n-A

  • M-(CL1L2)n-T-A

  • M-T1-(CL1L2)n-T2-A
  • As to the chemical moieties T, T1 or T2, there are no particular restrictions as to their chemical nature with the proviso that L has in particular chemical properties enabling carrying out the inventive method for the preparation of the novel derivatives and providing suitable chemical properties for the novel derivatives as far as their intended use is concerned.
  • Therefore, T, T1 and/or T2 may comprise optionally substituted aryl residues, suitable heteroatoms, suitable functional groups, or the like. As far as functional groups are concerned, embodiments may be mentioned according to which these functional groups result from the preparation of the crosslinking compound wherein at least a first compound and at least a second compound are reacted with each other to give a compound M-L-A. By way of example, a first compound M-L′-W1 and a second compound W2-L″-A may be reacted to give crosslinking compound M-L-A wherein -L- is -L′-F-L″- and F represents the functional group resulting from the reaction of functional group W1 with functional group W2, and wherein at least one of L′ and L″ comprises the structure unit —(CL1L2)n-. Such functional groups W1 and W2 may be suitably chosen. By way of example, one of groups W1 and W2, i.e. W1 or W2, may be chosen from the group consisting of the functional groups according to the following list while the other group, W2 or W1, is suitable selected and capable of forming a chemical linkage with W1 or W2, wherein W2 or W1 is also preferably selected from the above-mentioned group:
      • C—C-double bonds or C—C-triple bonds or aromatic C—C-bonds;
      • the thio group or the hydroxy group;
      • alkyl sulfonic acid hydrazides, aryl sulfonic acid hydrazides;
      • 1,2-dioles;
      • 1,2-amino-thioalcohols;
      • azides;
      • 1,2-aminoalcohols;
      • the amino group —NH2 or derivatives of the amino groups comprising the structure unit —NH— such as aminoalkyl groups, aminoaryl group, aminoaralkyl groups, or alkarylamino groups;
      • the hydroxylamino group —O—NH2, or derivatives of the hydroxylamino group comprising the structure unit —O—NH—, such as hydroxylalkylamino groups, hydroxylarylamino groups, hydroxylaralkylamino groups, or hydroxylalkarylamino groups;
      • alkoxyamino groups, aryloxyamino groups, aralkyloxyamino groups, or alkaryloxyamino groups, each comprising the structure unit —NH—O—;
      • residues having a carbonyl group, -Q-C(=G)-M′, wherein G is O or S, and M′ is, for example,
        • —OH or —SH;
        • an alkoxy group, an aryloxy group, an aralkyloxy group, or an alkaryloxy group;
        • an alkylthio group, an arylthio group, an aralkylthio group, or an alkarylthio group;
        • an alkylcarbonyloxy group, an arylcarbonyloxy group, an aralkylcarbonyloxy group, an alkarylcarbonyloxy group;
        • activated esters such as esters of hydroxylamines having imid structure such as N-hydroxysuccinimid;
      • —NH—NH2, or —NH—NH—;
      • —NO2;
      • the nitril group;
      • carbonyl groups such as the aldehyde group or the keto group;
      • the carboxy group;
      • the —N═C═O group or the —N═C═S group;
      • vinyl halide groups such as the vinyl iodide or the vinyl bromide group or triflate;
      • —C≡C—H;
      • —(C═NH2Cl)—OAlkyl
      • groups —(C═O)—CH2-Hal wherein Hal is Cl, Br, or I;
      • —CH═CH—SO2—;
      • a disulfide group comprising the structure —S—S—;
      • the group
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00021
      • the group
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00022
  • By way of example, W1 or W2 may be a carboxy group or an activated ester, and W2 or W1 may be an amino group or a hydroxy group such that F representing the functional group resulting from the reaction of functional group W1 with functional group W2, is an amid or an ester.
  • Therefore, by way of example, crosslinking compounds having a spacer L comprising, apart from structure unit —(CL1L2)n-, a functional group, may have a constitution such as

  • M-L′-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)n-A

  • or

  • M-L′-(C═O)—O—(CL1L2)n-A

  • or

  • M-L′-NH—(C═O)—(CL1L2)n-A

  • or

  • M-L′-O—(C═O)—(CL1L2)n-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—NH-L″-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—O-L″-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)n-NH—(C═O)-L″-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)n-O—(C═O)-L″-A
  • wherein L′ and L″ may or may not comprise a structure unit —(CL1L2)n-.
  • Among these structures, crosslinking compounds are preferred having constitutions

  • M-L′-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)n-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—NH-L″-A
  • Also, among these structures, spacers are preferred wherein L′ and L″, if present, contain the structure unit —(CL1L2)n-. In these cases, it is even more preferred that n is in the range of from 1 to 4, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 3, such as 1, 2, or 3. If a given spacer contains, for example, two structure units —(CL1L2)n-, index n of each structure unit may be the same or different.
  • Therefore, the following crosslinking compounds are preferred having the following constitutions:

  • M-(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)n-A
  • wherein each n is, independently from each other, preferably in the range of from 1 to 4, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 3, such as 1, 2, or 3. Accordingly, preferred spacers L have the constitution

  • —(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)n
  • Thus, particularly preferred crosslinking compounds containing —(C═O)—NH— are

  • M-(CL1L2)3-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)3-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)3-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)2-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)2-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)3-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)2-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)2-A
  • More preferred crosslinking compounds containing —(C═O)—NH— are

  • M-(CL1L2)3-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)2-A

  • or

  • M-(CL1L2)2-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)2-A
  • Even more preferably, L1 and L2 are both H. Thus, crosslinking compounds having the following constitutions

  • M-(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)3-A

  • or

  • M-(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2-A

  • or

  • M-(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)3-A

  • or

  • M-(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2-A
  • are especially preferred.
  • Crosslinking compounds having the following constitutions

  • M-(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2-A

  • or

  • M-(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2-A
  • are most preferred.
  • By way of example, preferred crosslinking compounds of the present invention are
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00023
  • Again by way of example and in order to illustrate above-discussed structures, a crosslinking compound conceivable in the context of the present invention may be
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00024
  • According to a further embodiment of the present invention, spacer L may comprise more than one structure units —(CL1L2)n- wherein these structure units may be same or different, i.e. the structure may differ in n and/or L1 and/or L2, wherein at least two such structure units may be separated by a heteroatom such as O or S. Preferably, according to this embodiment, the spacer L comprises at least one structure unit —(CL1L2)n1-O—(CL1L2)n2-, preferably —(CH2)n1—O—(CH2)n2 wherein n1 is equal to or different from n2, and wherein the spacer L is linked via —(CL1L2)n1- to the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, i.e. the crosslinking compound comprising the following sub-structure

  • M-(CL1L2)n1-O—(CL1L2)n2
  • According to a preferred conceivable embodiment, spacer structures such as

  • —((CL1L2)n1-O)m—(CL1L2)n2
  • may be mentioned, with m being an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6 such as 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6. Particularly preferably, m is 1, 2, or 3, more preferably 2 or 3. Preferably, n1 is from 2 to 4, and more preferably 2. Preferably, n2 is from 1 to 4, more preferably 1 or 2. Therefore, preferred structures are, by way of example,

  • —((CL1L2)2-O)m—(CL1L2)—
  • and more preferably

  • —((CH2)2—O)m—CH2
  • Again by way of example and in order to illustrate above-discussed structures, a crosslinking compound preferably used in the context of the present invention is
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00025
  • According to a further embodiment of the present invention, group M and group A may be separated by 2 suitable chemical moieties, at least one thereof comprising —(CL1L2)n-, such that the N atom of group M and the C atom of ketal group A are forming a ring. A preferred embodiment was already presented above and has the structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00026
  • Especially preferred crosslinking compounds of the present invention are compounds having, as group M, the group H2N— or the group H2N—O— or the group H2N—NH—(C═O)—, especially preferably the group H2N—, and, as group A, an acetal group, preferably an acetal group having the structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00027
  • wherein, more preferably, Z1 and Z2 are O and, even more preferably, A1 and A2 are both ethyl. Even more preferably, the spacer L consists of structure unit —(CL1L2)n-, with L1 and L2 preferably being H, and integer n even more preferably being from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • Therefore, preferred crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are, by way of example,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00028
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00029
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00030
  • Even more preferably, the cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). More preferably, the cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). In particular, cross-linking compounds are selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • Particularly preferred as crosslinking compound M-L-A is 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00031
  • By way of example, conceivable amino-acetal crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00032
  • By way of example, conceivable amino-ketal crosslinking compounds according to the present invention are:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00033
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00034
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00035
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00036
  • Hydroxyalkyl Starch Derivative
  • Accordingly, the present invention relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) derivative obtainable or obtained by the method as described above.
  • Moreover, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative of formula (III)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00037
  • wherein A is an acetal or ketal group; L is a spacer bridging X and A;
    wherein X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of an amino group M of a crosslinking compound of formula (II)

  • M-L-A
  • with hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00038
  • via carbon atom C* of the HAS, wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M,
    wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
  • As far as preferred embodiments regarding HAS, preferably HES, L, A, R1, R2, and R3 are concerned, specific reference is made to the embodiments as described hereinabove.
  • Further, the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein R1, R2 and R3 are independently a group —(CH2CH2O)n—H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • Further, the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein the hydroxyalkyl starch is hydroxyethyl starch (HES).
  • Further, the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
  • wherein
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00039
  • Z1 and Z2 are each independently O or S or NRx, preferably O, wherein Rx is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl, preferably H;
    A1 and A2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzyl, methoxybenzyl, ethoxybenzyl, or are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00040
  • wherein A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2— or —(CH2)3— or —(CH2CH(CH3))—, and
    wherein A3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, A3 preferably being H.
  • The precise chemical nature of group X of the HAS derivative according to the invention depends on the respective chemical nature of group M, on the oxidation state of the carbon atom C* of the reducing end of HAS, and on the reaction conditions such as solvent, temperature and so forth employed for the reaction. According to embodiments of the present invention wherein the carbon atom C* is employed in oxidised and non-oxidised state, specific and preferred examples are discussed in detail hereinunder.
  • Preferably, as far as X is concerned, the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein X is selected from the group consisting of —CH═N—, —CH2—NH—, —CH═N—O—, —CH2—NH—O—, —C(═O)—NH—, —C(═O)—NH—NH—, —CH═N—NH—(C═O)—, —CH2—NH—NH—(C═O)—, preferably consisting of —CH2—NH—, —CH═N—, —CH═N—O—, —CH2—NH—O—, —CH═N—NH—(C═O)—, and —CH2—NH—NH—(C═O)—, more preferably consisting of —CH2—NH—, —CH═N—, —CH═N—O—, and —CH2—NH—O—.
  • For certain embodiments of the group X, it is conceivable that the terminal saccharide unit of the HAS as present in the HAS derivative is present in a ring structure which may be in equilibrium with the open structure according to formula (III) above, the ring structure and the open structure having a certain equilibrium distribution. In these cases, and for the purpose of the present invention, formula (III) as given above comprises the open structure as well as the ring structure, and formula (III) does not restrict the HAS derivative to the open structure. For specific and preferred examples are discussed in detail hereinunder, the ring structure is shown in some cases.
  • Further, the present invention relates to the HAS derivative as described above, wherein L bridging M and A is a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId), preferably consisting of a structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00041
  • wherein L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R″ wherein R″ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl; more preferably H,
    wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • The Optionally Oxidised Reducing End of HAS, Preferably HES
  • According to the present invention, HAS, preferably HES can be reacted via carbon atom C* of the terminal reducing end of the starch with amino group M of the crosslinking compound wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M.
  • The term “the HAS is reacted via the reducing end” or “the HAS is reacted via carbon atom C* of the terminal reducing end” as used in the context of the present invention may relate to a process according to which the HAS is reacted predominantly via its (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end.
  • This term “predominantly via its (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end” relates to processes according to which statistically more than 50%, preferably at least 55%, more preferably at least 60%, more preferably at least 65%, more preferably at least 70%, more preferably at least 75%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and still more preferably at least 95% such as 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% of the HAS molecules employed for a given reaction are reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end per HAS molecule, wherein a given HAS molecule which is reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end can be reacted in the same given reaction via at least one further suitable functional group which is comprised in said polymer molecule and which is not a reducing end. If one or more HAS molecule(s) is (are) reacted via at least one (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end and simultaneously via at least one further suitable functional group which is comprised in this (these) HAS molecule(s) and which is not a (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing end, statistically preferably more than 50%, preferably at least 55%, more preferably at least 60%, more preferably at least 65%, more preferably at least 70%, more preferably at least 75%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and still more preferably at least 95% such as 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, or 99% of all reacted functional groups of these HAS molecules, said functional groups including the (optionally selectively oxidised) reducing ends, are (selectively oxidised) reducing ends.
  • The term “reducing end” as used in the context of the present invention relates to the terminal aldehyde group of a HAS molecule which may be present as aldehyde group and/or as corresponding hemiacetal form and/or as acetal group, the acetal group having the following structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00042
  • which can be present if residue —OR3 according to formula (I) above is —O—CH2—CH2—OH.
  • In case the reducing end is oxidised, the oxidised reducing end is in the form of a carboxy group and/or of the corresponding lactone.
  • Oxidised Reducing End
  • Therefore, according to a first embodiment of the present invention, the crosslinking compound is reacted via the amino group with the oxidised C* atom of the terminal reducing end of HAS, preferably HES.
  • Although the oxidation may be carried out according to all suitable method or methods resulting in the oxidised reducing end of hydroxyalkyl starch, it is preferably carried out using an alkaline iodine solution as described, e.g., in Sommermeyer et al., U.S. Pat. No. 6,083,909, column 5, lines 63-67, and column 7, lines 25-39; column 8, line 53 to column 9, line 20, the respective content being incorporated into the present invention by reference.
  • Selectively oxidising the HAS, preferably the HES leads to HAS, preferably HES being a lactone
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00043
  • and/or a carboxylic acid
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00044
  • or a suitable salt of the carboxylic acid such as alkali metal salt, preferably as sodium and/or potassium salt, and HAS′ preferably being HES′.
  • According to a first alternative of the present invention, this form of the HAS, preferably HES, is reacted as such with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound.
  • According to a second alternative of the present invention, the HAS, preferably HES, selectively oxidised at its reducing end, is first reacted with a suitable compound to give the HAS, preferably HES, comprising a reactive carboxy group.
  • Introducing the reactive carboxy group into the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end may be carried out by all conceivable methods and all suitable compounds.
  • According to a specific method of the present invention, the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with at least one alcohol, preferably with at least one acidic alcohol such as acidic alcohols having a pKA value in the range of from 6 to 12 or of from 7 to 11 at 25° C. The molecular weight of the acidic alcohol may be in the range of from 80 to 500 g/mol, such as of from 90 to 300 g/mol or of from 100 to 200 g/mol.
  • Suitable acidic alcohols are all alcohols H—O—RA having an acidic proton and are capable of being reacted with the oxidised HAS to give the respective reactive HAS ester, preferably according to the formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00045
  • still more preferably according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00046
  • Preferred alcohols are N-hydroxy succinimides such as N-hydroxy succinimde or sulfo-N-hydroxy succinimide, suitably substituted phenols such as p-nitrophenol, o,p-dinitrophenol, o,o′-dinitrophenol, trichlorophenol such as 2,4,6-trichlorophenol or 2,4,5-trichlorophenol, trifluorophenol such as 2,4,6-trifluorophenol or 2,4,5-trifluorophenol, pentachlorophenol, pentafluorophenol, or hydroxyazoles such as hydroxy benzotriazole. Especially preferred are N-hydroxy succinimides, with N-hydroxysuccinimide and sulfo-N-hydroxysuccinimide being especially preferred. All alcohols may be employed alone or as suitable combination of two or more thereof. In the context of the present invention, it is also possible to employ a compound which releases the respective alcohol, e.g. by adding diesters of carbonic acid. Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method as described above, wherein the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is activated by reacting the oxidised HAS with an acidic alcohol, preferably with N-hydroxy succinimide and/or sulfo-N-hydroxy succinimide.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with at least one carbonic diester RB—O—(C═O)—O—RC, wherein RB and RC may be the same or different. Preferably, this method gives reactive HAS according to the formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00047
  • wherein HAS′ is preferably HES′.
  • As suitable carbonic diester compounds, compounds may be employed whose alcohol components are independently N-hydroxy succinimides such as N-hydroxy succinimde or sulfo-N-hydroxy succinimide, suitably substituted phenols such as p-nitrophenol, o,p-dinitrophenol, o,o′-dinitrophenol, trichlorophenol such as 2,4,6-trichlorophenol or 2,4,5-trichlorophenol, trifluorophenol such as 2,4,6-trifluorophenol or 2,4,5-trifluorophenol, pentachlorophenol, pentafluorophenol, or hydroxyazoles such as hydroxy benzotriazole. Especially preferred are N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate and sulfo-N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate, with N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate being especially preferred.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates a method as described above, wherein the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is activated by reacting the oxidised HAS with N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate.
  • The acidic alcohol is reacted with the oxidised HAS or the salt of the oxidised HAS at a molar ratio of acidic alcohol:HAS preferably of from 5:1 to 50:1, more preferably of from 8:1 to 20:1, at a preferred reaction temperature of from 2 to 40° C., more preferably of from 10 to 30° C. and especially preferably of from 15 to 25° C. The reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 to 10 h, more preferably of from 2 to 5 h, more preferably of from 2 to 4 h and particularly of from 2 to 3 h.
  • The carbonic diester compound is reacted with the oxidised HAS or the salt of the oxidised HAS at a molar ratio of diester compound:HAS generally of from 1:1 to 3:1, such as of from 1:1 to 1.5:1. The reaction time is generally in the range of from 0.1 to 12 h, like of from 0.2 to 6 h, or of from 0.5 to 2 h or of from 0.75 to 1.25 h.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, reacting the oxidised HAS with acidic alcohol and/or carbonic diester is carried out in at least one aprotic solvent, such as in an anhydrous aprotic solvent having a water content of not more than 0.5 percent by weight, preferably of not more than 0.1 percent by weight. Suitable solvents are, among others, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), N-methylpyrrolidone, dimethyl acetamide (DMA), dimethyl formamide (DMF) and mixtures of two or more thereof. The reaction temperatures are preferably in the range of from 2 to 40° C., more preferably of from 10 to 30° C.
  • For reacting the oxidised HAS with the at least one acidic alcohol, at least one additional activating agent is employed.
  • Suitable activating agents are, among others, carbonyldiimidazole, carbodiimides such as diisopropyl carbodiimde (DIC), dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC), 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC), with dicyclohexyl carbodiimides (DCC) and 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl) carbodiimide (EDC) being especially preferred.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, where the HAS which is oxidised at its reducing end, is reacted with an acidic alcohol in the presence of an additional activating agent to give the reactive HAS ester.
  • According to one embodiment of the present invention, the reaction of the oxidised HAS with carbonic diester and/or acidic alcohol is carried out at a low base activity which may be determined by adding the reaction mixture to water with a volume ratio of water to reaction mixture of 10:1. Prior to the addition, the water which comprises essentially no buffer, has a pH value of 7 at 25° C. After the addition of the reaction mixture and by measuring the pH value, the base activity of the reaction mixture is obtained, having a value of preferably not more than 9.0, more preferably of not more than 8.0 and especially preferably of not more than 7.5.
  • According to another embodiment of the present invention, the oxidised HAS is reacted with N-hydroxy succinimide in dry DMA in the absence of water with EDC to selectively give the polymer N-hydroxy succinimide ester according to the formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00048
  • more preferably with HAS′ being HES′.
  • This reaction does not give by-products resulting from reactions of EDC with OH groups of HES, and the rearrangement reaction of the O-acyl isourea formed by EDC and the oxidised HAS to the respective N-acyl urea is surprisingly suppressed.
  • According to another preferred embodiment of the present invention, the oxidised HAS is reacted with N,N′-disuccinimidyl carbonate in dry DMF in the absence of water and in the absence of an activating agent to selectively give the HAS-N-hydroxy succinimide ester according to the formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00049
  • more preferably with HAS′ being HES′.
  • According to another embodiment of the present invention, the HAS which is selectively oxidised at its reducing end is reacted at the oxidised reducing end with an azolide such as carbonyldiimidazole or carbonyl dibenzimidazole to give a polymer having a reactive carboxy group. In the case of carbonyldiimidazole, a reactive imidazolide HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00050
  • results, wherein HAS′ is preferably HES′.
  • The reactive HAS derivative comprising at least one reactive carboxy group, preferably resulting from the reaction of the HAS with the acidic alcohol, the carbonate and/or the azolide, as described above, is then further reacted with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound M.
  • Reaction of the HAS via the oxidised reducing end, optionally further activated as described above, with amino group M can be carried out according to all suitable methods. Preferably, the amino group M is a primary amino group H2N— or a secondary amino group.
  • Generally, preferably polar aprotic solvents are used which may also contain a certain amount of water, such as up to 10 wt.-%. Preferred aprotic solvents are, among others, DMSO or DMF.
  • An example of a preferred reaction temperature range is from 0 to 80° C., more preferably from 0 to 70° C., more preferably from 0 to 60° C., more preferably from 0 to 50° C. and even more preferably from 0 to 40° C.
  • If crosslinking compounds are used for reaction with HAS having the reducing end in oxidised form which, according to a preferred embodiment, have H2N— as amino group M, a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an amid bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted via its oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 80° C., and wherein X is —(C═O)—NH—.
  • Accordingly, the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative, obtainable or obtained by the method as described above.
  • Moreover, the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative as such, having the following structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00051
  • wherein R′ is H if the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a primary amino group, and wherein R′ is a chemical moiety other than H if the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a secondary amino group. The precise chemical nature of R′ is dependent on the crosslinking compound, and thus, reference is made to the discussion of the generally possible and preferably employed crosslinking compounds hereinabove.
  • In accordance with above-described preferred crosslinking compounds employed for the present invention, the following HAS derivatives may be mentioned as preferred embodiments by way of example, wherein in each case, HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention—HES:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00052
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00053
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00054
  • The HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18) are more preferred. Even more preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). Particularly preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • According to an especially preferred embodiment, the present invention relates to a HES derivative having the following structure:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00055
  • wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • Non-Oxidised Reducing End
  • According to a second and preferred embodiment of the present invention, the crosslinking compound is reacted via amino group with the non-oxidised C* atom of the terminal reducing end of HAS, preferably HES, i.e. the terminal aldehyde group of a HAS molecule may be present as aldehyde group and/or as corresponding hemiacetal form.
  • Reaction of the HAS via the non-oxidised reducing end, with amino group M can be carried out according to all suitable methods. Preferably, the amino group M is H2N—, a suitable secondary amino group HNR′— such as, e.g., H3C—NH—, H2N—O—, or a suitable secondary hydroxyamino group HNR′—O— such as, e.g., H3C—NH—O—, or H2N—NH—(C═O)—.
  • Preferably, the amino group M is H2N—, H2N—O— or H2N—NH—(C═O)—, even more preferably H2N— or H2N—O—, and in particular H2N—.
  • According to a preferred embodiment of the present invention, this reaction is carried out in an aqueous system. The term “aqueous system” as used in this context of the present invention refers to a solvent or a mixture of solvents comprising water in the range of from at least 10% per weight, preferably at least 50% per weight, more preferably at least 80% per weight, even more preferably at least 90% per weight or up to 100% per weight, based on the weight of the solvents involved. As additional solvents, solvents such as DMSO, DMF, ethanol or methanol may be mentioned.
  • According to a preferred embodiment, if HAS is reacted with the crosslinking compound in an aqueous medium and the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a hydroxylamine or a hydrazide, the temperature of the reaction is preferably in the range of from 5 to 45° C., more preferably in the range of from 10 to 30° C. and especially preferably in the range of from 15 to 25° C.
  • According to another preferred embodiment, if HAS is reacted with the crosslinking compound in an aqueous medium and the amino group M of the crosslinking compound is a group H2N— or R′HN—, the reaction being a reductive amination, the temperature is preferably in the range of up to 100° C., more preferably in the range of from 10 to 90° C., more preferably in the range of from 20 to 80° C., more preferably in the range of from 30 to 70° C. and especially preferably in the range of from 40 to 60° C.
  • During the course of the reaction the temperature may be varied, preferably in the above-given ranges, or held essentially constant.
  • The reaction time for the reaction of HAS with crosslinking compound M may be adapted to the specific needs and is generally in the range of from 1 h to 7 d. In case, e.g., amino group M is a hydroxylamine or a hydrazide, the reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 h to 3 d, more preferably of from 2 h to 48 h, and especially preferably of from 3 to 24 h.
  • In case, e.g., the reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound is a reductive amination, the reaction time is preferably in the range of from 1 h to 7 d, more preferably in the range of from 4 h to 6 d, more preferably in the range of from 8 h to 5 d and even more preferably in the range of from 16 h to 3 d.
  • The pH value for the reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound may be adapted to the specific needs such as the chemical nature of the reactants. In case, e.g., group M of the crosslinking compound is a hydroxylamine or a hydrazide, the pH value is preferably in the range of from 3 to 9, more preferably of from 4 to 8 and even more preferably of from 4.5 to 6.5.
  • In case, e.g., the reaction of HAS with the crosslinking compound is a reductive amination, the pH value is preferably in the range of from 3 to 9, more preferably in the range of from 3.5 to 8, and even more preferably in the range of from 4 to 6.
  • The suitable pH value of the reaction mixture may be adjusted, for each reaction step, by adding at least one suitable buffer. Among the preferred buffers, acetate buffers, preferably sodium acetate buffer, phosphate or borate buffers may be mentioned.
  • If crosslinking compounds are used for reaction with HAS having the reducing end in non-oxidised form which, according to a preferred embodiment, have H2N— as amino group M, a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an imine bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A. If the reaction is carried out under reductive amination conditions in the presence of a suitable reducing agent, a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an amine bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 20 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4 to 7, X being —CH═N—.
  • Further, the present invention also relates to the above-described method, wherein in (i), the reaction is carried out in the presence of a reducing agent, such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex, preferably NaCNBH3, to obtain a HAS derivative, X being —CH2—NH—.
  • The concentration of these reducing agents used for the reductive amination of the present invention is preferably in the range of from 0.01 to 2.0 mol/l, more preferably in the range of from 0.05 to 1.5 mol/l, and more preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 1.0 mol/l, relating, in each case, to the volume of the reaction solution.
  • According to above-described preferred embodiment wherein M is H2N— and reaction of the crosslinking compound with HAS is carried out under reductive amination conditions, the molar ratio of crosslinking compound:HAS is preferably in the range of from 1:1 to 100:1, more preferably from 2:1 to 80:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 70:1, more preferably from 4:1 to 60:1, and more preferably from 5:1 to 50:1.
  • According to above-described preferred embodiment wherein M is H2N— and reaction of the crosslinking compound with HAS is carried out under reductive amination conditions, the concentration of HAS, preferably HES, in the aqueous system is preferably in the range of from 1 to 50 wt.-%, more preferably from 3 to 45 wt.-%, and more preferably from 5 to 40 wt.-%, relating, in each case, to the weight of the reaction solution.
  • If crosslinking compounds are used for reaction with HAS having the reducing end in non-oxidised form which, according to a preferred embodiment, have H2N—O— or H2N—NH—(C═O)— as amino group M, a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via an —CH═N—O— bond or —CH═N—NH—(C═O)— bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A. If the reaction is carried out under reducing conditions in the presence of a suitable reducing agent, a HAS derivative is obtained by step (i) of the present invention wherein the HAS and the crosslinking compound employed as starting materials are linked via a —CH2—NH—O— bond or —CH2—NH—NH—(C═O)— bond, wherein the obtained HAS derivative further contains the acetal or keto group A.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—O— or H2N—NH—(C═O)—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 5 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4.5 to 6.5, X being —CH═N—O— or —CH═N—NH—(C═O)—. Further, the present invention also relates to the above-described method, wherein in (i), the reaction is carried out in the presence of a reducing agent, such as sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex, preferably NaCNBH3, to obtain a HAS derivative, X being —CH2—NH—O— or —CH2—NH—NH—(C═O)—.
  • The concentration of these reducing agents used for this reaction of the present invention is preferably in the range of from 0.001 to 2.0 mol/l, more preferably in the range of from 0.01 to 1.0 mol/l, and more preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 0.8 mol/l, relating, in each case, to the volume of the reaction solution.
  • According to above-described preferred embodiment wherein M is H2N—O— or H2N—NH—(C═O)—, and the reaction of the crosslinking compound with HAS is carried out under reducing conditions, the molar ratio of crosslinking compound:HAS is preferably in the range of from 1:1 to 100:1, more preferably from 2:1 to 80:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 70:1, more preferably from 4:1 to 60:1, and more preferably from 5:1 to 50:1.
  • According to above-described preferred embodiment wherein M is H2N— and reaction of the crosslinking compound with HAS is carried out under reductive amination conditions, the concentration of HAS, preferably HES, in the aqueous system is preferably in the range of from 1 to 50 wt.-%, more preferably from 3 to 45 wt.-%, and more preferably from 5 to 40 wt.-%, relating, in each case, to the weight of the reaction solution.
  • Accordingly, the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative, obtainable or obtained by the method(s) as described above.
  • Moreover, the present invention also relates to the HAS derivative as such, having the following structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00056
  • wherein, depending on the reaction conditions and/or the specific chemical nature of the crosslinking compound, the C—N double bond may be present in E or Z conformation where also a mixture of both forms may be present having a certain equilibrium distribution;
    or, as far as the corresponding ring structure is concerned which for the purposes of the present invention shall be regarded as identical to the open structure above,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00057
  • wherein depending on the reaction conditions and/or the specific chemical nature of crosslinking compound, these HAS derivatives may be present with the N atom in equatorial or axial position where also a mixture of both forms may be present having a certain equilibrium distribution; or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00058
  • or the corresponding ring structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00059
  • or the corresponding ring structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00060
  • In accordance with above-described preferred crosslinking compounds, the following HAS derivatives may be mentioned as preferred embodiments by way of example, wherein in each case, HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention—HES:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00061
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00062
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00063
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00064
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00065
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00066
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00067
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00068
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included,
    or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00069
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00070
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00071
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00072
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00073
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00074
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00075
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00076
  • wherein the corresponding ring structure is included, or
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00077
  • The HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a4), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18) are more preferred. Even more preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), (a14), (a16), and (a18). Particularly preferred are the HAS derivatives based on the cross-linking compounds selected from the group consisting of structures (a2), (a11), (a12), and (a16).
  • According to an especially preferred embodiment, the present invention relates to a HES derivative having the following structure:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00078
  • the corresponding ring structure
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00079
  • wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
    Other Conceivable Embodiments with Regard to HAS
  • For the sake of completeness, it shall be mentioned that, while not preferred according to the present invention, it might be conceivable that HAS is oxidised prior to the reaction with the crosslinking compound such that at least two aldehyde groups would be introduced into HAS according to the following formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00080
  • Generally, each oxidation agent or combination of oxidation agents might be employed capable of oxidising at least one saccharide ring of the polymer to give an opened saccharide ring having at least one, preferably at least two aldehyde groups. This reaction might be illustrated by the following reaction scheme showing a saccharide ring of HAS which is oxidised to give an opened ring having two aldehyde groups:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00081
  • Suitable oxidising agents are, among others, periodates such as alkaline metal periodates or mixtures of two or more thereof, with sodium periodate and potassium periodate being preferred. It might be conceivable that these aldehyde groups could be reacted with the crosslinking compound M-L-A via amino group M.
  • Isolation and/or Purification
  • Generally, it is conceivable that the HAS derivative from step (i) of the present invention is subsequently reacted as described hereinunder. According to a preferred embodiment, the HAS derivative from step (i) is suitably purified after the reaction step (i).
  • For the purification of the HAS derivative from step (i), the following possibilities A) to C) can be mentioned by way of example, wherein possibility A) is preferred:
    • A) Ultrafiltration using water or an aqueous buffer solution having a concentration preferably of from 0.1 to 100 mmol/l, more preferably from 1 to 50 mmol/l and more preferably from 5 to 20 mmol/l such as about 10 mmol/ml, a pH in the range of preferably from 2 to 10, more preferably from 4 to 10, more preferably from 6 to 10 and more preferably from 8 to 10 such as about 9; the number of exchange cycles preferably is from 10 to 50, more preferably from 10 to 40 and even more preferably from 10 to 30 such as about 20.
    • B) Dialysis using water or aqueous buffer solution having a concentration preferably of from 0.1 to 100 mmol/l, more preferably from 1 to 50 mmol/l and more preferably from 5 to 20 mmol/l such as about 10 mmol/ml, a pH in the preferred range of from 2 to 10, more preferably from 4 to 10, more preferably from 6 to 10 and more preferably from 7 to 9; wherein a solution is employed containing the HAS derivative in a preferred concentration of from 5 to 20 wt.-%; and wherein buffer or water is used in particular in an excess of about 100:1 to the HES derivative solution.
    • C) Precipitation with ethanol or isopropanol, centrifugation and re-dissolving in water to obtain a solution having a preferred concentration of about 10 wt-%, and subsequent ultrafiltration using water or an aqueous buffer solution having a concentration of preferably from 0.1 to 100 mmol/l, more preferably from 1 to 50 mmol/l and even more preferably from 5 to 20 mmol/l such as about 10 mmol/ml, a pH in the preferred range of from 2 to 10, more preferably from 4 to 10, more preferably from 6 to 10 and more preferably from 7 to 9; the number of exchange cycles is preferably from 10 to 40, more preferably from 10 to 30 and even more preferably from 10 to 20 such as 10.
  • After the preferred purification step, the HAS derivative is preferably obtained as a solid. According to further conceivable embodiments of the present invention, HAS derivative solutions or frozen HAS derivative solutions may be mentioned having preferred HAS derivative contents of from 2 to 40 wt.-%, wherein the pH of these solutions is preferably in a range of from 3 to 10 and the concentration of the buffer used is preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 1 mol/l.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method as described above, wherein, after (i), the HAS derivative obtained in (i) is purified using ultrafiltration using water or an aqueous buffer solution having a concentration of from 0.1 to 100 mmol/l, a pH in the range of from 2 to 10, the number of exchange cycles being from 10 to 50.
  • Reaction with Biologically Active Agent BA
  • According to a further preferred embodiment, the present invention relates to a method wherein above-described HES derivative
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00082
  • is further suitably reacted with a biologically active compound BA via acetal or ketal group A, which group A is preferably transformed to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group prior to the reaction with BA.
  • Most preferably, group A, preferably the corresponding aldehyde or keto group is reacted with an amino group, still more preferably with a primary amino group comprised in BA. For such cases and for the purposes of the present invention, BA is also represented as H2N-BA′ wherein BA′ is the remainder of BA.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, further comprising
    • (ii) reacting the HAS derivative according to formula (III) via group A with an amino group of a biologically active agent H2N-BA′, via reductive amination, obtaining a HAS derivative according to formula (IV)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00083
  • According to a first embodiment of the present invention, the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is suitably subjected to a transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group wherein the resulting HAS derivative is subjected to a suitable purification and/or isolation step prior to the reaction with BA. The transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction. The reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C. and more preferably from 20 to 60° C., at a pH which is preferably in the range of from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 5, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably from 1 to 3 and even more preferably from 1 to less than 3. Purification and buffer-exchange of the hydrolysis reaction product can be achieved by methods well-known to those skilled in the art, e.g. by dialysis or ultrafiltration. The transformed material can be recovered from the solution as a solid e.g. by freeze-drying.
  • According to a second embodiment of the present invention, the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is suitably subjected to a transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group wherein the resulting HAS derivative is directly reacted with BA, i.e. without a separate suitable purification and/or isolation step of the HAS derivative comprising the aldehyde or keto group. The transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction. The reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C. and more preferably from 20 to 60° C., at a pH which is preferably in the range of from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 5, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably from 1 to 3 and even more preferably from 1 to less than 3. The hydrolysis reaction product can be combined with the BA in a buffered solution either directly or after having adjusted the pH to a value compatible with the reaction with the BA.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method as described above wherein prior to (ii), group A of the HAS derivative according to formula (III) is transformed to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group.
  • According to a third conceivable embodiment of the present invention, the HAS derivative obtained from (i) which has been preferably purified is directly reacted with BA, i.e. reacted with BA under reaction conditions allowing for the in situ transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group without a separate suitable purification and/or isolation step and without a separate step for the transformation of group A to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group. The transformation to the aldehyde or keto group is preferably performed by an acid-catalyzed hydrolysis reaction. The reaction is preferably carried out at a temperature of from 0 to 100° C., more preferably from 10 to 80° C. and more preferably from 20 to 60° C., at a pH which is preferably in the range of from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 5, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably from 1 to 3 and even more preferably from 1 to less than 3. The hydrolysis reaction product can be combined with the BA in a buffered solution either directly or after having adjusted the pH to a value compatible with the reaction with the BA.
  • Which method according to the above-mentioned three embodiments is carried out depends, for example, on the specific nature of the biologically active substance BA employed. If, e.g., a protein such as EPO, G-CSF or IFN alpha is employed as BA, above-identified first or second embodiment is generally suitable.
  • The reaction in step (ii) is preferably carried out in an aqueous system. The term “aqueous system” as used in this context of the present invention refers to a solvent or a mixture of solvents comprising water in the range of from at least 10% per weight, preferably at least 50% per weight, more preferably at least 80% per weight, even more preferably at least 90% per weight or up to 100% per weight, based on the weight of the solvents involved. As additional solvents, solvents such as DMSO, DMF, ethanol or methanol may be mentioned.
  • While it is conceivable to carry out the reaction in step (ii) under conditions to obtain the non-reduced form of the HAS derivative according to formula (IV), i.e.
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00084
  • it is particularly preferred to carry out the reaction according to step (ii) under reductive amination conditions in the presence of at least one suitable reducing agent. In particular, under these conditions the group —CH═N— obtained through the reaction of the aldehyde or keto group resulting from group A of the HAS derivative and the H2N-group of BA is reduced to —CH2—NH—.
  • By way of example, the following reducing agents may be employed: NaBH(OAc)3, sodium borohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride, organic borane complex compounds such as a 4-(dimethylamine)pyridine borane complex, N-ethyldiisopropylamine borane complex, N-ethylmorpholine borane complex, N-methylmorpholine borane complex, N-phenylmorpholine borane complex, lutidine borane complex, triethylamine borane complex, or trimethylamine borane complex. NaBH4 and NaCNBH3 are preferred, and NaCNBH3 is particularly preferred.
  • In one embodiment, the HAS derivative is added to an aqueous solution containing the biologically active agent. Preferably, subsequently the at least one reducing agent is added, in particular NaCNBH3.
  • In an alternative embodiment, the HAS derivative may be optionally brought into an aqueous solution, and then BA is added. Preferably, subsequently the at least one reducing agent is added, in particular NaCNBH3.
  • The reaction of the HAS derivative with the amino group of the biologically active compound BA in step (ii) is preferably carried out at a pH value of from 3 to 9, preferably of from 3 to 8, more preferably of from 3 to 7, more preferably from 3 to below 7, such as at a pH of 3 or 4 or 5 or 6. The suitable pH value of the reaction mixture may be adjusted by adding at least one suitable buffer. Among the preferred buffers, acetate buffers, preferably sodium acetate buffer, phosphate or borate buffers may be mentioned.
  • The reaction of the HAS derivative obtained in step b) with the amino group of the biologically active compound BA in step (ii) is preferably carried out at a temperature of from −10 to 100° C., preferably of from 0 to 50° C., more preferably of from 0 to 37° C., more preferably of from 0 to 25° C., such as 0, 5, 10, 15, 20, or 25° C.
  • The reaction time in step (ii) depends on the temperature, the ratio of HAS, in particular HES, derivative and compound BA and the absolute concentration of the HAS derivative and compound BA. Generally, reaction times from 5 min to 7 d, preferably from 1 h to 7 d are conceivable.
  • The molar ratio of HAS derivative obtained to compound BA in step (ii) is preferably from 0:1 to 200:1 equivalents, even more preferably from 1:1 to 100:1, based on the number average molecular weight (Mn) of the HAS derivative. Preferably, the molar ratio is from 1:1 to 50:1. Low molar ratios such as molar ratios of 50:1 or below, preferably from 1:1 to 20:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 10:1, and even more preferably from 2:1 to 9:1, more preferably from 3:1 to 8:1 and even more preferably from 4:1 to 7:1, are conceivable, for example, if BA is a protein, in particular IFN alpha.
  • In a particular preferred embodiment the concentration of the HAS derivative used in step (ii) is higher than about 10 wt.-%, in particular higher than about 15 wt.-%, in each case related to the weight of the reaction solution of (ii).
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to the method as described above, wherein in (ii), the reaction is carried out, preferably in an aqueous system, in the presence of a reducing agent, preferably NaCNBH3, at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 37° C., preferably 0 to 25° C. and a pH in the range of from 3 to 9, preferably 3 to below 7, and wherein in (ii), the molar ratio of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA is from 0.1:1 to 200:1 equivalents, preferably from 1:1 to 50:1 equivalents, based on the number average molecular weight (Mn) of the HAS derivative.
  • Preferred concentrations of BA, such as, e.g., preferred protein concentrations of the solution, preferably the aqueous solution, subjected to (ii) are in the range of from 0.1 to 10 g/l, more preferably from 1 to 9 g/l. The concentration of the HAS derivative in said solution, prior to (ii) and given in (w/v), is preferably in the range of from 0.1 to 50%, more preferably from 0.5 to 45% and more preferably from 1 to 40%.
  • According to a conceivable embodiment, the biologically active agent BA may be dissolved in an aqueous medium, preferably in an aqueous buffer solution, in particular in a sodium acetate buffer solution. The aqueous solution additionally may contain additives, such as detergents and/or dispersants, in particular selected from the group consisting of SDS, Chaps, Tween 20, Tween 80, Nonidet P-40, and Triton X 100. If a detergent and/or dispersant is used, it is preferably present in an amount of 0.005 to 3 wt.-%, preferably of 0.05 to 3 wt.-%, preferably about 0.5 wt.-%, based on the total weight of the aqueous solution.
  • If the at least one reducing agent is employed according to the present invention, and X, present in the HAS derivative employed for the reaction with BA, is, e.g., —CH═N—, —CH═N—O—, or —CH═N—NH—(C═O)— is preferably reduced to result in a functional group X, being —CH2—NH—, —CH2—NH—O—, or —CH2—NH—NH—(C═O)— under the reductive amination conditions used for the reaction in (ii).
  • The present invention thus also relates to the HAS derivative obtained or obtainable by the method as described above, in particular by a method as described above wherein in (ii), the reaction is carried out, preferably in an aqueous system, in the presence of a reducing agent, preferably NaCNBH3, at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 37° C., preferably 0 to 25° C. and a pH in the range of from 3 to 9, more preferably from 3 to 7, more preferably from 3 to below 7, and wherein in (ii), the molar ratio of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA is from 0.1:1 to 200:1 equivalents, preferably from 1:1 to 10:1 equivalents, based on the number average molecular weight (Mn) of the HAS derivative employed in step (ii), in each case with the proviso that X is not an amid group. Particularly preferred molar ratios of the HAS derivative to biologically active agent BA are below 10, such from 1:1 to 9:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 8:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 7:1, more preferably from 1:1 to 6:1 and even more preferably from 1:1 to 5:1, such as about 1:1, about 2:1, about 3:1, about 4:1, or about 5:1. While such low molar ratios like molar ratios of 50:1 or below, more preferably of 10:1 or below are conceivable for several biologically active agents, they are preferred for e.g. proteins wherein IFN alpha is especially preferred. As far as, e.g., G-CSF and EPO are concerned, molar ratios of 50:1 or below such as, e.g., from 1:1 to 50:1, are preferred. In general, by way of example, molar ratios in the range of from 1:1 to 50:1 or from 2:1 to 40:1 or from 3:1 to 30:1 or from 4:1 to 20:1 or from 5:1 to 15:1 may be mentioned.
  • In case a protein is employed as biologically active agent BA according to the present invention, and especially at the preferred pH ranges given above, particularly at a pH below 7 and greater or equal 3, to react the HAS derivative predominantly with the amino group located at the N terminus of the protein. The term “predominantly” as used in the context of the present invention relates to an embodiment where at least 50%, preferably at least 60%, preferably at least 70%, preferably at least 80%, preferably at least 85% of the N-terminal amino groups available are reacted via reductive amination. It is also possible to react at least 90% or at least 95% or at least 96% or at least 97% or at least 98% or at least 99% of the N-terminal amino groups available. Although coupling to amino groups other than the N-terminal amino group could not be ruled out completely, it is believed that coupling via reductive amination according to the present invention at a pH of below 7, takes place essentially selectively at the N-terminal amino group. In particular, these reaction conditions are preferred for proteins which are stable at these conditions. Should a protein e.g. be acid labile, such as alpha1-antitrypsin (A1AT), then it is preferred to choose appropriate reaction conditions, in particular a pH from lower than 7.5 to greater than 5.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method for the preparation of a HAS derivative comprising BA′, a HAS derivative obtainable or obtained by such method, and a HAS derivative according to formula (IV) as such, as described above, wherein the protein comprises the N-terminal amino group and at least one further amino group, said HAS derivative comprising the HAS being predominantly coupled to the N-terminal amino group.
  • Hence, the present invention also relates to a HAS derivative according to formula (IV)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00085
  • Moreover, the present invention also relates to a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative of formula (IV)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00086
  • wherein X is a functional group resulting from the reaction of an amino group M of a crosslinking compound of formula (II)

  • M-L-A  (II)
  • wherein X is not an amide group —C(═O)—NH—,
    with hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00087
  • via carbon atom C* of the HAS, wherein C* is optionally oxidised, most preferably not oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M,
    wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group,
    wherein A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00088
  • wherein
    Z1 and Z2 are each independently O or S or NRx, preferably O, wherein Rx is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl such as n-propyl or i-propyl, or C(O)—Ry wherein Ry is preferably selected from the group consisting of C1-C6 alkyl and C6-C14 aryl, even more preferably selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl; Rx preferably being H;
    A1 and A2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzyl, methoxybenzyl, ethoxybenzyl, or are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00089
  • wherein A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2— or —(CH2)3— or —(CH2CH(CH3))—, and wherein A3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, A3 preferably being H.;
    and wherein L is a spacer bridging M and A,
    wherein BA′ is the remainder of a biologically active agent BA′-NH2 remaining after the reaction of the amino group of BA via reductive amination with A or with the aldehyde group or keto group corresponding to A.
  • As to preferred embodiments with regard to HAS, preferably HES, and the crosslinking compound, reference is made to the respective disclosure above.
  • As far as the HAS derivative of formula (IV) is concerned, X is preferably selected from the group consisting of —CH2—NH—, —CH═N—, —CH2—NH—O—, and —CH═N—O—, more preferably —CH2—NH— and —CH2—NH—O—, most preferably —CH2—NH—.
  • Moreover, as far as the HAS derivative of formula (IV) is concerned, L bridging M and A is preferably a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId), preferably consisting of a structural unit according to formula (IId)
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00090
  • wherein L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R″ wherein R″ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl; more preferably H,
    wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
  • The term “biologically active substance” (BA) as used in the context of the present invention relates to a substance which can affect any physical or biochemical property of a biological organism including, but not limited to, viruses, bacteria, fungi, plants, animals, and humans. In particular, the term “biologically active substance” as used in the context of the present invention relates to a substance intended for diagnosis, cure, mitigation, treatment, or prevention of disease in humans or animals, or to otherwise enhance physical or mental well-being of humans or animals. Examples of active substances include, but are not limited to, peptides, polypeptides, proteins, enzymes, small molecule drugs, dyes, lipids, nucleosides, nucleotides, oligonucleotides such as, e.g., oligonucleotides having a suitable spacer such as 5′-aminohexyl spacer, polynucleotides, nucleic acids, cells, viruses, liposomes, microparticles, and micelles. Preferably, a biologically active substance according to the present invention contains a native amino group.
  • Examples of proteins include, but are not limited to, erythropoietin (EPO), such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO) or an EPO mimetic, colony-stimulating factors (CSF), such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), alpha-Interferon (IFN alpha), beta-Interferon (IFN beta) or gamma-Interferon (IFN gamma), such as IFN alpha and IFN beta like recombinant human IFN alpha or IFN beta (rhIFN alpha or rhIFN beta), interleukines, e.g. IL-1 to IL-34 such as IL-2 or IL-3 or IL-11 like recombinant human IL-2 or IL-3 (rhIL-2 or rhIL-3), serum proteins such as coagulation factors II-XIII like factor VIII, factor VII, factor IX, factor II, factor III, factor IV, factor V, factor VI, factor X, factor XI, factor XII, factor XIII, serine protease inhibitors such as alpha1-antitrypsin (A1AT), activated protein C (APC), plasminogen activators such as tissue-type plasminogen activator (tPA), such as human tissue plasminogen activator (hTPA), AT III such as recombinant human AT III (rhAT III), myoglobin, albumin such as bovine serum albumin (BSA), growth factors, such as epidermal growth factor (EGF), thrombocyte growth factor (PDGF), fibroblast growth factor (FGF), brain-derived growth factor (BDGF), nerve growth factor (NGF), B-cell growth factor (BCGF), brain-derived neurotrophic growth factor (BDNF), ciliary neurotrophic factor (CNTF), transforming growth factors such as TGF alpha or TGF beta, BMP (bone morphogenic proteins), growth hormones such as human growth hormone (hGH) like recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), tumor necrosis factors such as TNF alpha or TNF beta, somatostatine, somatotropine, somatomedines, hemoglobin, hormones or prohormones such as insulin, gonadotropin, melanocyte-stimulating hormone (alpha-MSH), triptorelin, hypthalamic hormones such as antidiuretic hormones (ADH and oxytocin as well as releasing hormones and release-inhibiting hormones, parathyroid hormone, thyroid hormones such as thyroxine, thyrotropin, thyroliberin, calcitonin, glucagon, glucagon-like peptides (GLP-1, GLP-2 etc.), exendines such as exendin-4, leptin, such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), Kemptide (Trp4-Kemptide), vasopressin, gastrin, secretin, integrins, glycoprotein hormones (e.g. LH, FSH etc.), melanoside-stimulating hormones, lipoproteins and apo-lipoproteins such as apo-B, apo-E, apo-La, immunoglobulins such as IgG, IgE, IgM, IgA, IgD and fragments thereof, such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), murin immunoglobuline G (mIgG), hirudin, tissue-pathway inhibitor, plant proteins such as lectin or ricin, bee-venom, snake-venom, immunotoxins, antigen E, alpha-proteinase inhibitor, ragweed allergen, melanin, oligolysine proteins, RGD proteins or optionally corresponding receptors for one of these proteins; prolactin or a mutant thereof, such as G129R, in which the wild type amino acid at position 129, glycine, is replaced by arginine (a tradename of this mutant is “LactoVert”) and a functional derivative or fragment of any of these proteins or receptors.
  • The polypeptide is preferably selected from the group consisting of erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), asparaginase such as recombinant asparaginase (rAsparaginase), leptin such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), interleukin-2, interleukine-11, alpha-1-antitrypsin, an antibody, or an antibody fragment, and an alternative protein scaffold.
  • More preferably, the polypeptide is selected from the group consisting of erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), asparaginase such as recombinant asparaginase (rAsparaginase), leptin such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), interleukine-2, interleukine-11, and alpha-1-antitrypsin.
  • The active substance is preferably selected from the group composed of antibiotics, antidepressants, antidiabetics, antidiuretics, anticholinergics, antiarrhythmics, antiemetics, antitussives, antiepileptics, antihistamines, antimycotics, antisympathotonics, antithrombotics, androgens, antiandrogens, estrogens, antiestrogens, antiosteoporotics, antitumor agents, vasodilators, other antihypertensive agents, antipyretic agents, analgesics, antiinflammatory agents, beta blockers, immunosuppressants and vitamins.
  • Some additional, non-restrictive examples of active substances are alendronate, amikazin, atenolol, azathioprine, cimetidine, clonidine, cosyntropin, cycloserine, desmopressin, dihydroergotamine, dobutamine, dopamine, epsilon-aminocaproic acid, ergometrine, esmolol, famotidine, flecamide, folic acid, flucytosine, furosemide, ganciclovir, glucagon, hydrazaline, isoproterenol, ketamine, liothyronine, LHRH, merpatricin, methyldopa, metoprolol, neomicin, nimodipine, nystatin, oxytocin, phentolamine, phenylephrine, procainamide, procaine, propranolol, ritodrine, sotalol, terbutaline, thiamine, tiludronate, tolazoline, trimethoprim, tromethamine, vasopressin; amifostine, amiodarone, aminocaproic acid, aminohippurate sodium, aminoglutethimide, aminolevulinic acid, aminosalicylic acid, amsacrine, anagrelide, anastrozole, asparaginase (such as recombinant asparaginase, e.g. from E. coli (rAsparaginae)), anthracyclines, bexarotene, bicalutamide, bleomycin, buserelin, busulfan, cabergoline, capecitabine, carboplatin, carmustine, chlorambucin, cilastatin sodium, cisplatin, cladribine, clodronate, cyclophosphamide, cyproterone, cytarabine, camptothecins, 13-cis retinoic acid, all trans retinoic acid; dacarbazine, dactinomycin, daunorubicin, deferoxamine, dexamethasone, diclofenac, diethylstilbestrol, docetaxel, doxorubicin, epirubicin, estramustine, etoposide, exemestane, fexofenadine, fludarabine, fludrocortisone, fluorouracil, fluoxymesterone, flutamide, gemcitabine, epinephrine, L-Dopa, hydroxyurea, idarubicin, ifosfamide, imatinib, irinotecan, itraconazole, goserelin, letrozole, leucovorin, levamisole, lisinopril, lovothyroxine sodium, lomustine, mechlorethamine, medroxyprogesterone, megestrol, melphalan, mercaptopurine, metaraminol bitartrate, methotrexate, metoclopramide, mexiletine, mitomycin, mitotane, mitoxantrone, naloxone, nicotine, nilutamide, octreotide, oxaliplatin, pamidronate, pentostatin, pilcamycin, porfimer, prednisone, procarbazine, prochlorperazine, ondansetron, raltitrexed, sirolimus, streptozocin, tacrolimus, tamoxifen, temozolomide, teniposide, testosterone, tetrahydrocannabinol, thalidomide, thioguanine, thiotepa, topotecan, tretinoin, valrubicin, vinblastine, vincristine, vindesine, vinorelbine, dolasetron, granisetron; formoterol, fluticasone, leuprolide, midazolam, alprazolam, amphotericin B, podophylotoxins, nucleoside antivirals, aroyl hydrazones, sumatriptan; macrolides such as erythromycin, oleandomycin, troleandomycin, roxithromycin, clarithromycin, davercin, azithromycin, flurithromycin, dirithromycin, josamycin, spiromycin, midecamycin, leucomycin, miocamycin, rokitamycin, andazithromycin, and swinolide A; fluoroquinolones such as ciprofloxacin, ofloxacin, levofloxacin, trovafloxacin, alatrofloxacin, moxifloxicin, norfloxacin, enoxacin, grepafloxacin, gatifloxacin, lomefloxacin, sparfloxacin, temafloxacin, pefloxacin, amifloxacin, fleroxacin, tosufloxacin, prulifloxacin, irloxacin, pazufloxacin, clinafloxacin, and sitafloxacin; aminoglycosides such as gentamicin, netilmicin, paramecin, tobramycin, amikacin, kanamycin, neomycin, and streptomycin, vancomycin, teicoplanin, rampolanin, mideplanin, colistin, daptomycin, gramicidin, colistimethate; polymixins such as polymixin B, capreomycin, bacitracin, penems; penicillins including pcnicillinase-sensitive agents like penicillin G, penicillin V; penicillinase-resistant agents like methicillin, oxacillin, cloxacillin, dicloxacillin, floxacillin, nafcillin; gram negative microorganism active agents like ampicillin, amoxicillin, and hetacillin, cillin, and galampicillin; antipseudomonal penicillins like carbenicillin, ticarcillin, azlocillin, mezlocillin, and piperacillin; cephalosporins like cefpodoxime, cefprozil, ceftbuten, ceftizoxime, ceftriaxone, cephalothin, cephapirin, cephalexin, cephradrine, cefoxitin, cefamandole, cefazolin, cephaloridine, cefaclor, cefadroxil, cephaloglycin, cefuroxime, ceforamide, cefotaxime, cefatrizine, cephacetrile, cefepime, cefixime, cefonicid, cefoperazone, cefotetan, cefinetazole, ceftazidime, loracarbef, and moxalactam, monobactams like aztreonam; and carbapenems such as imipenem, meropenem, pentamidine isethiouate, albuterol sulfate, lidocaine, metaproterenol sulfate, beclomethasone diprepionate, triamcinolone acetamide, budesonide acetonide, fluticasone, ipratropium bromide, flunisolide, cromolyn sodium, and ergotamine tartrate; taxanes such as paclitaxel; SN-38, and tyrphostines.
  • Therefore, also chemical compounds known to the skilled person as “small molecules” are conceivable biologically active substances according to the present invention. The term “small molecule” as used in this context of the present invention relates to a biologically active chemical compound other than a protein and an oligonucleotide, including, however, peptides of up to 50 amino acids. Typical examples of such small molecules are listed in the foregoing paragraph.
  • Examples for an oligonucleotide are aptamers and siRNA. Also to be mentioned are peptide nucleic acids (PNA) as conceivable biologically active substances.
  • Therefore, the present invention also relates to a method as described above and a HAS derivative as described above, wherein the protein is erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), asparaginase such as recombinant asparaginase (rAsparaginase), leptin such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), interleukin-2, interleukine-11, alpha-1-antitrypsin, an antibody, or an antibody fragment, or an alternative protein scaffold.
  • The term “alternative protein scaffold” as used in the context of the present invention relates to a molecule having binding abilities similar to a given antibody wherein the molecule is based on an alternative non-antibody protein framework. In this context, the articles by A. Skerra, T. Hey et al., and H. K. Binz (see list of references below) may be mentioned.
  • As far as the biologically active substances (BA) of the present invention are concerned, these compounds may comprise one or more amino groups for coupling according to stage (ii) of the present invention. For cases where BA as such does not comprise an amino group suitable for this coupling, it is conceivable that at least one such amino group is introduced into BA by suitable functionalisation via methods known to the skilled person, prior to subjecting BA to (ii).
  • In accordance with above-described biologically active agents, in particular with above-described preferred biologically active agents, and in accordance with above-described preferred crosslinking compounds and the HAS derivatives obtained therefrom, the following HAS derivatives may be mentioned as preferred embodiments by way of example, wherein in each case, HAS is—according to preferred embodiments of the present invention—HES:
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00091
    Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00092
  • wherein BA′ is a protein, more preferably, wherein the protein is erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor Vila (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobulin G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), asparaginase such as recombinant asparaginase (rAsparaginase), leptin such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), interleukine-2, interleukine-11, alpha-1-antitrypsin, an antibody, or an antibody fragment, or an alternative protein scaffold, in particular wherein the protein is EPO, IFN alpha or G-CSF. Even more preferably, HAS′ is HES′, wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight of from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, preferably of 0.7 to 1.3, such as 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, most preferably about 1.0, 1.1, 1.2 or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to especially preferred embodiments, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00093
  • wherein HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to further especially preferred embodiments, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00094
  • wherein HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from, 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to further especially preferred embodiments, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00095
  • wherein HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to further especially preferred embodiments, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00096
  • wherein HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to further especially preferred embodiments, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative according to formula
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00097
  • wherein HAS is preferably HES and wherein, even more preferably, HES has a mean molecular weight from about 1 to about 1000 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 800 kDa, more preferably from about 1 to about 500 kDa, more preferably from about 2 to about 400 kDa, more preferably from about 5 to about 300 kDa, more preferably from about 10 to about 200 kDa, in particular from about 50 to about 150 kDa, a molar substitution of 0.1 to 3, preferably 0.4 to 1.3, such as 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, or 1.3, and a ratio of C2:C6 substitution of preferably in the range of from 2 to 20, more preferably in the range of from 2 to 15 and even more preferably in the range of from 3 to 12.
  • According to a further aspect, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above, for use in a method for the treatment of the human or animal body.
  • Moreover, the present invention relates to a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above, as a therapeutic or prophylactic agent.
  • Furthermore, the present invention relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising in a therapeutically effective amount a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, or a HAS derivative comprising BA′ as described above, obtained or obtainable by a method as described above.
  • The HAS derivatives of the present invention, comprising BA′, may be administered by suitable methods such as e.g. enteral, parenteral or pulmonary methods preferably administered by i.v., s.c. or i.m. routes. The specific route chosen will depend upon the condition being treated. Preferably, the derivatives may be administered together with a suitable carrier, such as known in the art (e.g. as used in the first generation/unmodified biopharmaceutical, albumin-free or with albumin as an excipient), a suitable diluent, such as sterile solutions for i.v., i.m., or s.c. application. The required dosage will depend on the severity of the condition being treated, the patient's individual response, the method of administration used, and the like. The skilled person is able to establish a correct dosage based on his general knowledge.
  • As far as the pharmaceutical compositions according to the present invention comprising the HAS derivative comprising BA′, as described above, are concerned, the HAS derivatives may be used in combination with a pharmaceutical excipient. Generally, the HAS derivative will be in a solid form which can be combined with a suitable pharmaceutical excipient that can be in either solid or liquid form. As excipients, carbohydrates, inorganic salts, antimicrobial agents, antioxidants, surfactants, buffers, acids, bases, and combinations thereof may be mentioned. A carbohydrate such as a sugar, a derivatized sugar such as an alditol, aldonic acid, an esterified sugar, and/or a sugar polymer may be present as an excipient. Specific carbohydrate excipients include, for example: monosaccharides, such as fructose, maltose, galactose, glucose, D-mannose, sorbose, and the like; disaccharides, such as lactose, sucrose, trehalose, cellobiose, and the like; polysaccharides, such as raffinose, melezitose, maltodextrins, dextrans, starches, and the like; and alditols, such as mannitol, xylitol, maltitol, lactitol, xylitol, sorbitol (glucitol), pyranosyl sorbitol, myoinositol, and the like. The excipient may also include an inorganic salt or buffer such as citric acid, sodium chloride, potassium chloride, sodium sulfate, potassium nitrate, sodium phosphate monobasic, sodium phosphate dibasic, and combinations thereof. The pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise an antimicrobial agent for preventing or deterring microbial growth, such as, e.g., benzalkonium chloride, benzethonium chloride, benzyl alcohol, cetylpyridinium chloride, chlorobutanol, phenol, phenylethyl alcohol, phenylmercuric nitrate, thimersol, and combinations thereof. The pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise an antioxidant, such as, e.g., ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, hypophosphorous acid, monothioglycerol, propyl gallate, sodium bisulfite, sodium formaldehyde sulfoxylate, sodium metabisulfite, and combinations thereof. The pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise a surfactant, such as, e.g., polysorbates, or pluronics sorbitan esters; lipids, such as phospholipids such as lecithin and other phosphatidylcholines, phosphatidylethanolamines acids and fatty esters; steroids, such as cholesterol; and chelating agents, such as EDTA or zinc. The pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention may also comprise acids or bases such as, e.g., hydrochloric acid, acetic acid, phosphoric acid, citric acid, malic acid, lactic acid, formic acid, trichloroacetic acid, nitric acid, perchloric acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, fumaric acid, and combinations thereof, and/or sodium hydroxide, sodium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, ammonium acetate, potassium acetate, sodium phosphate, potassium phosphate, sodium citrate, sodium formate, sodium sulfate, potassium sulfate, potassium fumerate, and combinations thereof. Generally, the excipient will be present in pharmaceutical composition according to the present invention in an amount of 0.001 to 99.999 wt.-%, preferably from 0.01 to 99.99 wt.-%, more preferably from 0.1 to 99.9 wt.-%, in each case based on the total weight of the pharmaceutical composition.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is EPO, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of anemic disorders or hematopoietic dysfunction disorders or diseases related hereto.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is G-CSF, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of haemophilia A for the treatment of a disorder characterized by a reduced hematopoietic or immune function. According to a preferred embodiment, the disorder characterized by a reduced hematopoietic or immune function, is a result of chemotherapy, radiation therapy, infectious disease, severe chronic neutropenia, or leukemia.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN alpha, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of leukaemia e.g. hairy cell leukaemia, chronic myelogeneous leukaemia, multiple myeloma, follicular lymphoma, cancer, e.g. carcinoid tumour, malignant melanoma and hepatitis, e.g. chronic hepatitis B and chronic hepatitis C.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN gamma, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of osteoporosis and/or chronic malignant disease.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-2, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of osteoporosis and/or chronic malignant disease.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IL-11, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of platelet transfusions following myelosuppressive chemotherapy.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is A1AT, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of emphysema, cystic fibrosis, atopic dermatitis, and/or bronchitis.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is IFN beta, for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of multiple sclerosis, preferably relapsing forms of multiple sclerosis.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is factor VII for the preparation of a medicament for the treatment of episodes in hemophilia A or B patients with inhibitors to Factor VIII or Factor IX.
  • According to another aspect, the present invention also relates to the use of a HAS derivative, preferably a HES derivative as described above, wherein BA is factor IX for the preparation of a medicament for the control and prevention of hemorrhagic episodes in patients with hemophilia B, e.g. congenital factor IX deficiency or Christmas disease, including control and prevention of bleeding in surgical settings.
  • LIST OF REFERENCES
    • Sommermeyer et al., 1987, Krankenhauspharmazie, 8(8), 271-278
    • Weidler et al., 1991, Arzneimittelforschung/Drug Res., 41, 494-498
    • DE 26 16 086
    • Spivak and Hogans, 1989, Blood 73, 90
    • McMahon et al., 1990, Blood 76, 1718
    • WO 94/28024
    • WO 02/080979
    • WO 03/074087
    • WO 03/074088
    • WO 2005/014024
    • WO 2005/092390
    • WO 2004/024777
    • WO 2004/024776
    • WO 2005/092928
    • US 2006/0194940 A1
    • U.S. Pat. No. 7,157,546 B2
    • EP 1 591 467 A1
    • WO 2004/022630 A2
    • U.S. Pat. No. 6,916,962 B2
    • U.S. Pat. No. 6,956,135 B2
    • WO 03/049699 A2
    • U.S. Pat. No. 5,990,237
    • Klemm D. et al, Comprehensive Cellulose Chemistry Vol. 2, 1998, Whiley-VCH, Weinheim, N.Y., especially chapter 4.4, Esterification of Cellulose (ISBN 3-527-29489-9
    • WO 00/66633 A
    • WO 00/18893 A
    • U.S. Pat. No. 4,454,161
    • EP 0 418 945 A
    • JP 2001294601 A
    • US 2002/065410 A
    • U.S. Pat. No. 6,083,909
    • A. Skerra, Curr Opin Mol. Ther. 9(4), 2007, pp. 336-344
    • T. Hey et al., Trends Biotechnol. 23 (10), 2005, pp. 514-522
    • H. K. Binz et al., Nat. Biotechnol. 23 (10), 2005, pp. 1257-1268
    • WO2005/083103 A1
    • K. R. Reddy et al. Advanced Drug Delivery Reviews 54 (2002) pp. 571-586
    DESCRIPTION OF THE FIGURES
  • FIG. 1: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 1 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES-IFNa coupling reactions according to example 2. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mix.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lanes 1-4: reaction mixtures according to example 2.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (19 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 30 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 2: Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 2 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES55/0.7-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 2. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: Hi Trap Q HP 1 ml (GE Healthcare)
    • Eluent A: 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0.
    • Eluent B: 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash  2 CV 0% B
    elution 16 CV 0-50% B  
    regeneration
    10 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
     8 CV 0% B
    • Load: 2 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 2, 20fold diluted in Eluent A and adjusted to pH 8.0.
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 3: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 3 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction according to example 3. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions. Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to example 3.
    • Lane 2: EPO starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 55 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 4: Cation exchange chromatography of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 4 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES55/0.7-EPO coupling reaction according to example 3. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: HiTrap SP HP (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0.
    • Eluent B: 20 mM sodium acetate, 1M NaCl, pH 4.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 5 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash1
    2 CV 0% B
    wash2
    2 CV 10% B 
    elution
    21 CV  10-52% B   
    regeneration
    8 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
    5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 2 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 3, 10fold diluted in Eluent A
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 5: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 5 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 5. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mix.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • lane 1: reaction mixture according to example 5.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (19 kDa) becomes visible as a smcary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 6: Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 6 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 5. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: Hi Trap Q HP 5 ml (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0.
    • Eluent B: 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash 2 CV 0% B
    elution 12.5 CV   0-50% B  
    regeneration
    5 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
    5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 2 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 5, 20fold diluted in Eluent A and adjusted to pH 8.0
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 7: Peptide Mapping of an oxHES100/1.0-IFNa conjugate
  • FIG. 7 shows the chromatographic separation of an IEX-purified oxHES-IFNa conjugate according to example 5 treated with Endo-LysC.
  • The proteolysis was performed using 7.5% Endo-LysC in 50 mM Tris-Cl, pH 8.6, 0.01% SDS at 37° C. o/n. Samples were denatured with DTT and guanidinium chloride and analyzed by RP-HPLC on a 4.6×250 mm Jupiter C4 column (Phenomenex) run with a water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. The chromatograms shown were monitored at 214 nm.
  • The arrow indicates the region of the chromatogram where strong differences between the chromatograms for the protein (A) and the conjugate (13) are visible. The peaks for L1 and L1/L2 (the N-terminal peptide resulting from the Endo-Lys C treatment) is strongly reduced for the conjugate sample while the other fragments remain virtually unaffected. These data suggest a preferential coupling of the HES to the N-terminus of IFNa.
  • FIG. 8: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 8 shows the SD S-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 6. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: 10 μg EPO starting material prior to conjugation.
    • Lane 2: 5 μg EPO starting material prior to conjugation.
    • Lane 3: reaction mixture according to example 6.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (—35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 70 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 9: Cation exchange chromatography of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 14 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an oxHES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 6. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: 2×5 ml HiTrap SP HP (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0.
    • Eluent B: 20 mM sodium acetate, 1M NaCl, pH 4.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 5 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash1
     2 CV 0% B
    wash2
     2 CV 10% B 
    elution
    21 CV 10-52% B   
    regeneration 2.5 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
     5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 2 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 6, 10fold diluted in Eluent A
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 10: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 10 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 7. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to example 7.
    • Lane 2: G-CSF starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 11: RP-HPLC analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 11 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of an oxHES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 7 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm.
    • Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Summit, P580 (HPG) (Dionex).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μm, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-5 min, 5-55% B; 5-12 min, 55-68% B; 12-17 min, 100% B; 17-22 min, 5% B; gradient delay 2.5 min.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mix, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.1 mg/ml.
  • The main peak at 11.5 min is the HES protein conjugate separated from free G-CSF eluting at ˜13 min
  • FIG. 12: SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 12 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of a HES-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 10. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, unstained protein marker 5-200 kDa (Serva).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to example 9.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (19 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 13: Anion exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 13 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-IFNa coupling reaction according to example 10. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: 5 ml HiTrap SP HP (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0.
    • Eluent B: 20 mM sodium acetate, 1M NaCl, pH 4.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 5 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash1
     2 CV 0% B
    elution
    20 CV 0-50% B  
    regeneration
    10 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
     5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 3 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 9, 10fold diluted in Eluent A
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 14: SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 14 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 11. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: IEX purified HES EPO conjugate.
    • Lane 2: reaction mixture according to example 11.
    • Lane 3: 5 μg EPO starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 70 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 15: Cation exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 15 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reaction according to example 11. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: 4×5 ml HiTrap SP HP (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0.
    • Eluent B: 20 mM sodium acetate, 1M NaCl, pH 4.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 5 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration   5 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash1
      2 CV 0% B
    elution  13 CV 0-52% B  
    regeneration 2.5 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration 2.5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 3 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 11, 2fold diluted in Eluent A.
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 16: SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 16 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an HES 100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: IEX purified HES G-CSF conjugate.
    • Lane 2: reaction mixture according to example 12.
    • Lane 3: 5 μg G-CSF starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 17: RP-HPLC analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 17 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm.
    • Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Summit, P580 (LPG) (Dionex).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μm, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-5 min, 5-55% B; 5-12 min, 55-68% B; 12-17 min, 100% B; 17-22 min, 5% B; gradient delay 2.5 min.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.1 mg/ml.
  • The main peak at 10-10.5 min is the HES protein conjugate separated from free G-CSF eluting at ˜12 min.
  • FIG. 18: Cation exchange chromatography of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction
  • FIG. 18 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm on an ion exchange column of an HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reaction according to example 12. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: 2×5 ml HiTrap SP HP (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0.
    • Eluent B: 20 mM sodium acetate, 1M NaCl, pH 4.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 5 ml/min, 21° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 5 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash 2 CV 0% B
    elution
    15 CV  0-40% B  
    regeneration
    5 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
    5 CV 0% B
    • Load: 3 mg protein/ml resin as reaction mix according to example 12, 2fold diluted in Eluent A.
  • Non-reacted, excessive HES is found in the flowthrough. The HESylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIGS. 19-23 are referred to in the context of the respective examples.
  • FIG. 24
  • FIG. 24 shows a section of the HPGPC analysis of an oxHBS-BSA coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.2)” monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 280 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Shimadsu LC 10 AD/UV-Detektor: TSP UV 2000
    • Column: Superose 6 10/300 GL (Pharmacia).
    • Eluent: Phosphate buffer: (3.887 g Na2HPO4×2 H2O, 1.967 g NaH2PO4×2 H2O, 11.688 g NaCl, 0.05 g NaN3 were dissolved in water for chromatography (Reagent Pharmakopoea Europaea) up to a total volume of 1.0 l. The solution was filtered utilizing a 0.45 μm filter)
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 0.4 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Load: 0.9 mg protein as reaction mixture, dissolved in 100 μl to a protein concentration of 9 mg/ml.
  • The upper part shows the BSA starting material prior to the coupling reaction. From left to right, the peaks are at 38.038, 39.277, and 42.272.
  • The lower part shows the HBS-BSA conjugate. From left to right, the peaks are at 36.795, 39.345, and 41.521.
  • FIG. 25: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 25 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.3)”. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lanes 1-4: reaction mixtures according to “additional data (A.3)”.
  • Successful HBSylation of the target protein (19 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 30 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 26: Anion exchange chromatography of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction
  • FIG. 26 shows the chromatographic separation monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm of an oxHBS-IFNa coupling reaction according to additional data (A.3) using an ion exchange column. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Äkta Explorer 100 (GE Healthcare).
    • Column: Hi Trap Q HP 1 ml (GE Healthcare).
    • Eluent A: 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0.
    • Eluent B: 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Run parameters:
  • equilibration 10 CV 0% B
    sample load
    wash  2 CV 0% B
    elution 16 CV 0-50% B  
    regeneration
    10 CV 100% B 
    reequilibration
     8 CV 0% B
    • Load: reaction mixture according to example 3, 20fold diluted in Eluent A and adjusted to pH 8.0.
  • Non-reacted, excessive HBS is found in the flowthrough. The HBSylation weakens the interaction of the protein with the column resulting in decreased elution times for the conjugate as compared to the unmodified protein.
  • FIG. 27: SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-EPO coupling reaction
  • FIG. 27 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of an oxHBS-EPO coupling reaction according to “additional data (A.4)”. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • Load: 10 μg protein as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to “additional data (A.4)”.
    • Lane 2: EPO starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HBSylation of the target protein (˜35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 45 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 28: RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a2) and (Trp4)-Kemptide
  • FIG. 28 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a2) and (Trp4)-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 3 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Shimadzu LC 20 Prominence, LC 20AT (LPG) (Shimadzu).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μm, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-15 min, 2-30% B; 15-20 min, 30-98% B; 20-27 min, 2% B.
    • Load: 5 μg protein as reaction mixture, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.05 mg/ml.
  • The main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp4)-Kemptide eluting at ˜17 min.
  • FIG. 29: RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a16) and (Trp4)-Kemptide
  • FIG. 29 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (al 6) and (Trp4)-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 13 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Shimadzu LC 20 Prominence, LC 20AT (LPG) (Shimadzu).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μm, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-15 min, 2-30% B; 15-20 min, 30-98% B; 20-27 min, 2% B.
    • Load: 5 μg protein as reaction mixture, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.05 mg/ml.
  • The main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp4)-Kemptide eluting at ˜17 min.
  • FIG. 30: RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a11) and (Trp4)-Kemptide
  • FIG. 30 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a11) and (Trp4)-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 24 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Shimadzu LC 20 Prominence, LC 20AT (LPG) (Shimadzu).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μM, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-15 min, 2-30% B; 15-20 min, 30-98% B; 20-27 min, 2% B.
    • Load: 5 μg protein as reaction mixture, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.05 mg/ml.
      The main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp4)-Kemptide eluting at ˜17 min.
  • FIG. 31: RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a12) and (Trp4)-Kemptide
  • FIG. 31 shows a section of the RP-HPLC analysis of a coupling reaction using HES100/1.0, linker (a12) and (Trp4)-Kemptide according to example 18, Table 5, line 30 monitored by UV-Vis spectroscopy at 221 nm. Chromatography conditions were as follows:
    • Chromatography system: Shimadzu LC 20 Prominence, LC 20AT, (LPG) (Shimadzu).
    • Column: Jupiter C18, 300A, 5 μm, 4.6×150 mm (Phenomenex).
    • Eluent A: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in water.
    • Eluent B: 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid in acetonitrile.
    • Operating conditions: flow rate 1 ml/min, 20° C.
    • Gradient: 0-15 min, 2-30% B; 15-20 min, 30-98% B; 20-27 min, 2% B.
    • Load: 5 μg protein as reaction mixture, diluted in water to a protein concentration of 0.05 mg/ml.
  • The main peak at 11.5-15 min is the HES Peptide conjugate separated from free (Trp4)-Kemptide eluting at ˜17 min
  • FIG. 32: SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reactions
  • FIG. 32 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-G-CSF coupling reactions according to example 18. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and a MES running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 7 (10 μg protein loaded).
    • Lane 2: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 16 (10 μg protein loaded).
    • Lane 3: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 27 (10 μg protein loaded).
    • Lane 4: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 33 (10 μg protein loaded).
    • Lane 5: 0.5 μg rhG-CSF starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜18 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
  • FIG. 33: SDS-PAGE analysis of HES100/1.0-IFNa and HES100/1.0-EPO coupling reactions
  • FIG. 33 shows the SDS-PAGE analysis of coupling reactions between HES100/1.0 and rhIFNα or rhEPO according to example 18. The separation was performed under reducing conditions using the NuPAGE system (Invitrogen) with 4-12% Bis-Tris gels (1.0 mm) and MOPS running buffer according to the manufacturers instructions. For the electrophoretic separation shown on the right MES buffer was used instead of MOPS.
    • Typical load: 10 μg protein either starting material or as reaction mixture.
    • M: Marker, Mark12 (Invitrogen).
    • Lane 1: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 4.
    • Lane 2: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 14.
    • Lane 3: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 25.
    • Lane 4: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 31.
    • Lane 5: rhIFNα starting material prior to conjugation.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜19 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 50 to >200 kDa.
    • Lane 6: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 15.
    • Lane 7: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 5.
    • Lane 8: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 32.
    • Lane 9: rhEPO starting material prior to conjugation.
    • Lane 10: reaction mixture according to Table 5, line 26.
  • Successful HESylation of the target protein (˜35-40 kDa) becomes visible as a smeary band with a broad mass distribution ranging from 60 to >200 kDa.
  • EXAMPLES Example 1 Preparation of oxHES55/0.7-N-(3-Propioaldehydediethylacetal)
  • HES aldonic acid (oxHES) was synthesized as described in example 9 of WO 2005/083103 A (in said document, the preparation is described for a hyperbranched starch, HBS) starting from HES with a molecular weight of 55 kDa and a molar substitution of 0.7 (HES55/0.7).
  • 30 g oxHES 55/0.7, dried for 2 d at 80° C., were dissolved in 60 ml dry dimethylformamide (DMF) and the solution was heated to 70° C. 25 g 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane in 50 ml dry DMF were added and the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 48 h.
  • DMF and excess 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane were removed at 60-80° C. in vacuo utilizing a rotary evaporator. The remaining crude solid was washed with acetone until no colour was detectable in the washing solution. The product was dissolved in 500 ml water and purified by ultrafiltration utilizing a membrane with a cut-off of 10000 Dalton. When the pH of the retentate had reached a value of 6-7, it was readjusted to 9 utilizing 0.1 M sodium hydroxide solution. This procedure was repeated four times. Finally the product was lyophilised.
  • Example 2 Preparation of oxHES 55/0.7 Interferon alpha 2b (IFNa) conjugate
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 1 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. for 24 h to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli (E. coli), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • A 10fold molar excess of oxHES aldehyde (based on Mw) was used with a protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 6 mg/ml; the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 1) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0, Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>50% B in 16 CV (FIG. 2).
  • Example 3 Preparation of oxHES 55/0.7 Erythropoietin (EPO) conjugates
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 1 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. for 24 h to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • The deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon®(Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5). OxHES aldehyde was added at a 10fold molar excess (based on Mw) compared to the EPO concentration. The resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mixture was 5 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 10% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 0° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 3) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0, Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 10% B, 2CV; 10% B=>52% B in 21 CV (FIG. 4).
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate. The conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • Example 4 Preparation of oxHES100/1.0-N-(3-Propioaldehydediethylacetal)
  • HES aldonic acid (oxHES) was synthesized as described in example 9 of WO 2005/083103 A (in said document, the preparation is described for a hyperbranched starch, HBS) starting from HES with a molecular weight of 100 kDa and a molar substitution of 1.0 (HES100/1.0).
  • 30 g oxHES 100/1.0, dried for 2 d at 80° C., were dissolved in 150 ml dry dimethylformamide (DMF) and the solution was heated to 70° C. 25 g 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane in 60 ml dry DMF were added and the reaction mixture was heated at 70° C. for 48 h.
  • DMF and excess 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane were removed at 60-80° C. in vacuo utilizing a rotary evaporator. The remaining crude solid was washed with acetone until no colour was detectable in the washing solution. The product was dissolved in 500 ml water and purified by ultrafiltration utilizing a membrane with a cut-off of 10,000 Dalton. When the pH of the retentate had reached a value of 6-7, it was readjusted to 9 utilizing 0.1 M sodium hydroxide solution. This procedure was repeated four times. Finally the product was lyophilised.
  • Example 5 Preparation of HES 100/1.0 Interferon alpha (IFNa) conjugate from oxidized HES
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 4 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. o/n to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli (E. coli), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • A 6fold molar excess of oxHES aldehyde (based on Mn) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 8 mg/ml; the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 5) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated Interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0, Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>50% B in 12.5 CV (FIG. 6).
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate. The conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone (FIG. 7).
  • Example 6 Preparation of an HES 100/1.0 Erythropoietin (EPO) conjugate from oxidized HES
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 4 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated at 21° C. for 24 h to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • The deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5). OxHES aldehyde was added at a 15fold molar excess (based on Mn) compared to the EPO concentration. The resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mixture was 3.7 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 15% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 8) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0, Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 10% B, 2 CV; 10% B=>52% B in 21 CV (FIG. 9).
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate. The conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • Example 7 Preparation of an HES 100/1.0 Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor (G-CSF) Conjugate from Oxidized HES
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 4 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated at 21° C. o/n to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • The deprotected oxHES aldehyde was combined with a rh-Met-G-CSF solution (5 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5; G-CSF expressed by E. coli having the same amino acid sequence and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Neupogen® from Amgen, München, D). OxHES aldehyde was added at a 30fold molar excess (based on Mn) compared to the G-CSF concentration. The resulting G-CSF concentration in the reaction mixture was 1.9 mg/ml, the oxHES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 0° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 10) and reversed phase chromatography (FIG. 11) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • Example 8 Preparation of HES100/1.0-N-(3-Propioaldehydediethylacetal)
  • 15 g HES 100/1.0 were dissolved in 35 g sodium acetate buffer (pH=5 and c=1 mol/l) and 2.07 ml of 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane as well as 1.885 g of sodium cyano borohydride were added. The reaction mixture was stirred at 60° C. for 16-24 h, diluted with 100 ml water, neutralized with diluted sodium hydroxide solution and worked up by ultrafiltration using a membrane with a cut-off of 10,000 Da against ammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (pH=9, c=10 mmol/l, 45 cycles) as well as water for the last 5 exchange cycles. The purified and concentrated HES derivative solution (approximately 20 wt-%) was dialyzed against sodium hydroxide solution (pH=12) at 60° C. using a membrane with a cut off of 10,000 Da. Thereafter the product was isolated by lyophilisation.
  • Example 9 Preparation of HES100/1.0-N-(3-Propioaldehyde)
  • 10 g of HES-N-(3-Propioaldehydediethylacetal) from example 8 were dissolved in 100 ml of aqueous HCl, pH=2 (c=10 mmol/l) and stirred at 40° C. for 16-24 h. The reaction mixture was purified by ultrafiltration using a membrane with a cut off of 10,000 Da against aqueous HCl, pH=2 (10 cycles) as well as water for the last 5 exchange cycles. The isolation of the product was carried out by lyophilisation.
  • Example 10 Preparation of an HES 100/1.0 Interferon Alpha (IFNa) Conjugate from HES
  • To 400 mg of acetal prepared in example 8 an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. o/n to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli (E. coli), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • A 5fold molar excess of HES aldehyde (based on Mw) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 7 mg/ml; the HES aldehyde concentration was 18% (w/v). The deprotected HES aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 12) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated IFNalpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0, Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>50% B in 20 CV (FIG. 13).
  • HES coupling sites in the target protein were identified by peptide mapping of the IEX-purified HES-protein conjugate. The conjugates were digested using a suitable protease (2% Endoproteinase Lys-C, pH 8.6, 37° C., o/n) and the resulting fragments were separated by reversed phase chromatography on a C4 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with TFA. HESylation sites in the protein could be identified indirectly by reduction or disappearance of the respective peptides in the chromatogram as compared to control digests of the target protein alone.
  • Example 11 Preparation of an HES 100/1.0 Erythropoietin (EPO) Conjugate from HES
  • The deprotected HES aldehyde from example 9 was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5). HES aldehyde was added at a 40fold molar excess (based on Mn) compared to the EPO concentration. The resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mix was 3.2 mg/ml, the HES aldehyde concentration was 30% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 5° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 14) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated EPO was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0, Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>52% B in 13 CV (FIG. 15).
  • Example 12 Preparation of an HES 100/1.0 Granulocyte Colony Stimulating Factor (G-CSF) Conjugate from HES
  • The deprotected HES aldehyde from example 9 was combined with a rh-Met-G-CSF solution (5 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5; G-CSF expressed by E. coli having the same amino acid sequence and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Neupogen® from Amgen, München, D). HES aldehyde was added at a 40fold molar excess (based on Mn) compared to the G-CSF concentration. The resulting G-CSF concentration in the reaction mix was 1.3 mg/ml, the HES aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to determine the conjugation yield. Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • Reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 16) and reversed phase chromatography (FIG. 17) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution of the RP-HPLC was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HESylated G-CSF was separated from non-reacted compounds by cation-exchange chromatography using an SP HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 20 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.0, Eluent B was 20 mM sodium acetate, 1 M NaCl, pH 4.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>40% B in 15 CV (FIG. 18).
  • Example 13 Pharmacodynamic In-Vivo Bioassay in Mice (HES-EPO Conjugate According to Example 11)
  • Balb C mice obtained from Harlan Winkelmann GmbH (Borchen, Germany) weighing approximately 18-20 grams were group housed (max. 10 per cage) in Euro Standard Typ III (L×B×H 425×266×185 mm) cages at a room temperature of 21° C. and a relative humidity of 55%. “Tapvei Einstreu” 4×4×1 mm (wood of Aspen) was used as bedding material for the cages. Additionally wood wool was offered. The cages were changed and cleaned once a week. Drinking water (pH 3.8-4; sulfuric acid) was offered ad libitum. The animal cages were numbered. Within a cage the animals were ear marked and additionally colour coded. On the day of allocation approx. and one week before commencement of treatment, an initial health check has been performed. Only healthy animals were used.
  • The HES EPO conjugate as obtained in example 11, the unmodified starting material (rHuEPO) and Aranesp® from Amgen were tested as a single bolus, subcutaneous dose in 4 mice per group at a dosage of 100 μg/kg body weight, based on the protein content of the samples. The same volume of PBS as vehicle control was included.
  • At several time points ( day 0, 3, 6, 9, 13, 16, 20, and 23) samples of approximately 30-60 μl whole blood were taken from the tail vein or the retrobulbar venous plexus using “Hämatokrit-Kapillaren” containing Na-heparin (Hirschmann Laborgeräte, Germany) and the whole blood was centrifuged for 6 minutes at 10.000 rpm in a Hettich Hamatocrit 210 centrifuge (Tuttlingen, Germany) to determine the hematocrit of each whole blood sample. The erythropoietic response and duration were monitored as a function change of hematocrit [%] as a function of time (see FIG. 19)
  • These data show that all samples containing EPO, Aranesp® or EPO conjugate were capable in raising the hematocrit. Aranesp® was capable to increase the potency compared to starting material 3-4 fold and as well the HES EPO conjugate was capable to increase the potency of 1.5-2 fold compared to Aranesp®.
  • Example 14 Pharmacodynamic In-Vivo Bioassay in Mice (HES-IFN Alpha Conjugate According to Example 5)
  • One oxHES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugate, prepared according to Example 5 was tested in the in vivo assay according to example 13. The EC50 dilution of the serum samples was half-logarithmically plotted against the time after iv.-injection. Half-life was calculated from the slope of the exponential fit-curve. The half life of the sample was 8.9 hours (see FIG. 20).
  • The relative in vitro activity of an oxHES100/1.0 Interferon alpha conjugate, prepared according to Example 5 compared to Intron A is shown in FIG. 21 (as to the determination of the in vitro activity, see example 16 below).
  • Example 15 Pharmacodynamic In-Vivo Bioassay in Mice (HES-IFN Alpha Conjugate According to Example 10)
  • Three HES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugates, prepared according to Example 10 were tested in the in vivo assay according to example 13. The medium of the EC50 dilution of the serum samples was half-logarithmically plotted against the time after iv.-injection. Half-life was calculated from the slope of the exponential fit-curve. The average half life of the samples was 9.7 hours (FIG. 22).
  • For unmodified IFN-alpha, the antiviral activity of serum was too low to calculate a serum half-life. In K. R. Reddy et al. Advaced Drug Delivery Reviews 54 (2002) pp. 571-586 a serum half-life of IFN-alpha in rats (i.v.) of 2 h was determined.
  • The relative in vitro activity of three HES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugates, prepared according to Example 10 compared to Intron A is shown in FIG. 23 (as to the determination of the in vitro activity, see example 16 below).
  • Example 16 Description of the Test Procedure: Antiviral Activity of Interferon-Alpha (Examples 14 and 15)
  • After pre-diluting the Test Items in cell culture medium, serial two-fold dilutions were prepared. In 96 well microtiter plates, diluted Interferon was added—in four-fold replicate per dilution- to freshly trypsinized MDBK cells (40.000 cells per well). The assays were incubated for 24 hours at 37° C. (total volume per well: 175 μl.
  • Subsequently, 50 μL diluted VSV stock solution were added to each well (except for the positive control wells) resulting in a multiplicity of infection of 0.1.
  • The following controls were included in each assay: 12 wells that received virus plus cell culture medium instead of Interferon (negative control) and 12 wells that received cell culture medium instead of Interferon and virus (positive control).
  • The assays were incubated for 42 hours at 37° C.
  • At the end of the incubation period the cell culture supernatant of each well was replaced with 50 μL of a solution of MTT (at least 2 mg/mL in cell culture medium). The cells were incubated for three hours. The purple formazan dye formed by the proliferating cells was solubilized by adding 100 μL solution of isopropanol/HCl (isopropanol with 40 mM HCl) to each well. Subsequently, the absorbance values of the solutions were measured at 570/630 nm in a microtiter plate reader.
  • The proliferative activity of MDBK cells grown in the presence of Interferon and VSV was calculated for each dilution of Interferon as follows:
  • ( ( Mean absorbance of four Interferon treated wells ) - ( Mean absorbance of negative control ) ) * 100 ( Mean absorbance of positive control ) - ( Mean absorbance of negative control )
  • The antiviral activity of Interferon-alpha was determined in four separate assays for each of the Test Items.
  • In the assay system described above, the respective conjugates HES100/1.0 Interferon alpha Conjugate (example 15 and 10, respectively) and oxHES100/1.0-Interferon alpha Conjugate (example 14 and 5, respectively) were tested compared to unmodified IFN-alpha starting material, namely Intron A. The CPE50 concentration of the materials was calculated.
  • Example 17 Preparation of HES-Linker Derivatives According to the Invention
  • In example 17, inventive HES-linker derivatives were produced. On the one hand, for a given linker structure, HES was varied with respect to the mean molecular weight, and with respect to its molar substitution. On the other hand, the chemical nature of the linker was varied, for a given HES starting material.
  • The amounts of HES indicated in the following Tables 1 and 2 were dissolved in the appropriate volume (“buffer V”) of sodium acetate buffer (1 mol/l, pH=5) by vigorous stirring and moderate heating (up to 40° C.). To the clear solution, the indicated amount of linker (40 equivalents referred to Mn of the HES species) was added. In some cases, the amount of linker was added as a “DMF-linker” solution. Therefore the required amount of linker was dissolved in a small amount of DMF and the resulting clear DMF-linker solution, indicated in Table 2 as “DMF-linker solution V” was added to the reaction mixture. Finally, solid NaCNBH3, indicated as NaCNBH3 amount was dissolved in the stirred solution to give a final concentration of typically 0.6 M, and the reaction mixture was heated and stirred at 60° C. for 18-24 h.
  • To work up the reaction, the mixture was diluted by ultrapure water to give a final concentration of about 100 mg/ml (10% m/V) HES derivative and purified either by ultrafiltration (UF) or by dialysis (D) using a membrane with a cut-off of 10 kDa and ultrapure water as solvent. In case of linker (a2) and (a3), 10 mM NH4HCO3-buffer, pH=9 following by ultrapure water was used for the ultrafiltration.
  • For the subsequent deprotection, the purified HES-derivative solution (10%, 100 mg/ml) was acidified by concentrate HCl solution to give the “c (HCl)” with the appropriate “pH level”. The mixture was stirred and heated at 40° C. for the reaction time “t” and afterwards neutralized (dil. NaOH), worked up by ultrafiltration (membrane cut-off 10 kDa) using the appropriate “work up solvent” and finally lyophilized to give a white to yellowish powder.
  • The derivatization was verified by successfully coupling to a target molecule (Kemptide, see the following example 18, Tables 3, 4, and 5). For the HES-derivatives, prepared using linker (a15) and (a10), the successful derivatization was checked by spectral properties. All HES-derivatives, prepared as described above were used for the conjugation to the targets, listed in example 18 in Tables 3, 4, and 5.
  • Abbreviations used in Tables 1 and 2:
  • D dialysis
    DMF dimethylformamide
  • HES Hydroxyethylstarch
  • HCl hydrochloric acid
    NaCNBH3 sodium cyano borohydride
    NaOH sodium hydroxide
    UF ultrafiltration
  • V Volume
  • Water ultrapure water (milliQ)
  • The HES-Derivative of HES 100/1.0 and linker structure (a2) was prepared according to Examples 8 and 9 of this invention. Linker structure (a2) relates to the structure (a2) as defined hereinabove, i.e. to 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane,
  • Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00098
  • TABLE 1
    Variation of HES moiety (example 17)
    Derivatization
    Starting material HES Linker NaCNBH3
    HES amount amount amount buffer Kind of
    linker species [g] [ml] [g] V [ml] work up*
    (a2) 100/1.0 15 2.07 1.885 35 UF
    (a2)  30/0.4 5 1.7 0.628 11.7 UF
    (a2)  30/1.0 10 2.94 1.256 23.3 UF
    (a2)  60/0.7 5 0.69 0.628 11.67 UF
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/0.7 5 0.82 0.628 11.67 UF
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2)  60/1.0 15 2.25 1.884 35 UF
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/1.0 5 0.8 0.628 11.67 UF
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2) 100/0.4 5 0.42 0.628 11.67 UF
    (a2) 100/0.7 5 0.52 0.628 11.67 UF
    (a2) 100/1.3 5 0.43 0.628 11.67 UF
    (a2) 150/0.4 5 0.32 0.628 11.67 UF
    (a2) 150/1.0 15 0.95 1.885 11.67 UF
    (a2) 300/1.0 5 0.16 0.628 11.67 UF
    Starting material Deprotection
    HES c (HCl) pH
    linker species [mM] level t [h] Work up solvent
    (a2) 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2)  30/0.4 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2)  30/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2)  60/0.7 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/0.7 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2)  60/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2) 100/0.4 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2) 100/0.7 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2) 100/1.3 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2) 150/0.4 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2) 150/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a2) 300/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    *NH4HCO3-buffer (10 mM, pH = 9) followed by ultrapure water was used for the ultrafiltration.
  • TABLE 2
    Variation of the linker structure (example 17)
    Derivatization
    Starting material HES linker NaCNBH3 DMF linker
    HES amount amount amount buffer solution rxn Kind of
    linker species [g] [mg] [g] V [ml] V [ml] V work up
    (a1)# 100/1.0 5 366    628.3 11.67 D
    (a3)# 100/1.0 15 1058    1883 35 UF
    (a4)# 100/1.0 1 135.5  125.6 2 0.33 2.33 D
    (a16)# 100/1.0 1 138    125.6 2 0.33 2.33 D
    (a17)# 100/1.0 10 1654    1256 23.3 UF
    (a11)# 100/1.0 1 136    125.6 2 0.33 2.33 D
    (a12)# 100/1.0 1 144.6  125.6 2 0.33 2.33 D
    (a13)# 100/1.0 0.5 72.4  62.83 1 0.16 1.67 D
    (a18)# 100/1.0 10 1479    1256 23.3 UF
    (a5)# 100/1.0 0.5 72.72 94.25 *1.95 + 0.05   UF**
    (HOAc)
    (a14)# 100/1.0 0.5 85.81 62.8 1.17 D
    (a15)# 100/1.0 0.5 83   62.83 *1.0 + 0.08  UF**
    (HOAc)
    (a10)#  60/1.0 0.2 20&   6.5 + 43 μl 1.6 + 0.1 D
    DMSO (HOAc)
    (a21)# 100/1.0 1 55.3  3.34 D
    Starting material Deprotection
    HES c (HCl) pH
    linker species [mM] level t [h] Work up solvent
    (a1)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a3)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 10 mM HCl/water
    (a4)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a16)# 100/1.0 100  1 2 water
    (a17)# 100/1.0 100  1 2 water
    (a11)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a12)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a13)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a18)# 100/1.0 100  1 2 water
    (a5)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a14)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a15)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    (a10)#  60/1.0
    (a21)# 100/1.0 10 2 18-24 water
    #as defined in the context of the present invention
    *DMSO instead of sodium acetate buffer
    **centrifugation of diluted and neutralized reaction mixture before ultrafiltration
    &20 equivalents instead of 40 (referred to Mn of HES) were used.
  • Example 18 Preparation of HES-Linker-Biologically Active Agent Derivatives According to the Invention
  • The amount of the target molecule as indicated in the following Tables 3, 4, and 5 was transferred into the appropriate reaction buffer. The indicated amount of the HES-linker derivative (defined by the linker and the HES species) was dissolved in reaction buffer and mixed with the target substance solution. NaCNBH3—typically as a freshly prepared 0.5 M stock solution in reaction buffer—was added to a final concentration of typically 20 mM. The reaction mixture was incubated under temperature control at the temperature “rxn T” for the reaction time “rxn t”.
  • The final reaction volume (“rxn V”) and the resulting concentrations and ratios of the reactants are given in Tables 3, 4, and 5.
  • The success of the conjugation reaction was shown by chromatographic analysis (RP-HPLC, SE-HPLC) or SDS-PAGE (see FIGS. 28 to 33 for selected derivatives). In all coupling reactions described herein a target-HES conjugate was detectable. The reaction conditions for the various target molecules were not optimized.
  • Abbreviations used:
    • rhIFNα: recombinant human interferon-alpha 2b
    • rhEPO: recombinant human erythropoietin
    • rhG-CSF: recombinant human granulocyte colony stimulating factor with an additional N-terminal methionine
    • rhFIX recombinant human clotting factor IX
    • rhFVIIa: recombinant human clotting factor Vila
    • rhGH recombinant human growth hormone
    • hFab Fab fragment derived from a human immunoglobuline G molecule
    • mIgG murine immunoglobuline G
    • GLP-1 Glucagon-like peptide-1; Amino acids 1-37
    • rAsparaginase recombinant asparaginase from E. coli
    • NH2-DNA Oligonucleotide with 5′-Aminohexylspacer having the sequence GGC TAC GTC CAG GAG CCA CCT
    • rhLeptin recombinant human leptin
    • AmphoB Amphotericin B, CAS No. 1397-89-3
    • Kemptide Trp4-Kemptide (Leu-Arg-Arg-Trp-Ser-Leu-Gly), CAS No. 80224-16-4
    • NaOAc sodium acetate containing buffer
    • HEPES 4-(2-Hydroxyethyl)-1-piperazineethanesulfonic acid, CAS No. 7365-45-9
  • TABLE 3
    Variation of target substances (example 18)
    HES
    HES target target amount HES: HES %
    linker species molecule buffer system amount [mg] target (w/v)
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc, pH 4 3 mg 76  5:1 18
    (Mw)
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhFIX 0.1M HEPES, pH 7 3.5 mg 133 29:1 25
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 40 μg 2.6 50:1 16
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhGH 0.1M Citrate, pH 6 0.1 mg 16 60:1 40
    (a2) 100/1.0 mIgG 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 3 80:1 3
    (a2) 100/1.0 hFab 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 50 μg 3.8 60:1 20
    (a2) 100/1.0 GLP-1 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 30 μg 26 60:1 20
    (a2) 100/1.0 rAsparaginase 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 30 μg 4 80:1 26
    (a2) 100/1.0 NH2-DNA 0.05M HEPES, pH 7 10 μg 5.5 60:1 20
    10 mM Mg2+
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 22.5 60:1 25
    (a2) 100/1.0 AmphoB 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5; 20 μg 78 60:1 40
    80% DMSO
    (a2) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1  20
    target
    linker HES target conc. NaCNBH3 rxn V rxn T rxn t
    structure species molecule [g/l] [mg] [μl] [° C.] [h]
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 7 20 425 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhFIX 6.7 20 531 10 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 2.5 20 16 10 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhGH 2.5 20 41 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 mIgG 0.9 20 107 5 48
    (a2) 100/1.0 hFab 2.7 20 19 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 GLP-1 0.2 20 83 21 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rAsparaginase 2 20 15 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 NH2-DNA 0.4 20 16 30 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 1.1 20 90 10 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 AmphoB 0.1 20 195 21 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.5 20 61 5 18
  • TABLE 4
    Variation of the HES moiety (example 18)
    HES target HES HES:
    linker species target buffer system [mg] [mg] target HES %
    (a2)  30/0.4 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 40 8:1 6.5
    (a2)  30/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 52 8:1 8.3
    (a2)  60/0.7 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 97 8:1 16
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/0.7 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 82 8:1 13
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 94 8:1 15
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 85 8:1 14
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2) 100/0.4 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 10 314 8:1 25
    (a2) 100/0.7 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 130 8:1 21
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 125 8:1 20
    (a2) 100/1.3 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 154 8:1 15
    (a2) 150/0.4 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 10 415 8:1 33
    (a2) 150/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 5 187 8:1 30
    (a2) 300/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 10 2437 24:1  40
    (a2)  30/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 4.5 173 50:1  23
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 4.5 313 40:1  30
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 60 5683 40:1  30
    (a2) 150/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 4.5 885 50:1  35
    target
    HES conc. NaCNBH3 rxn T rxn t
    linker species target [g/l] [mM] rxn V [° C.] [h]
    (a2)  30/0.4 rhIFNα 8 20 626 μl 5 18
    (a2)  30/1.0 rhIFNα 8 20 625 μl 5 18
    (a2)  60/0.7 rhIFNα 8 20 625 μl 5 18
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/0.7 rhIFNα 8 20 625 μl 5 18
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhIFNα 8 20 628 μl 5 18
      C2/C6 = 6
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhIFNα 8 20 625 μl 5 18
       C2/C6 = 8.5
    (a2) 100/0.4 rhIFNα 8 20 1257 μl 5 18
    (a2) 100/0.7 rhIFNα 8 20 624 μl 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 8 20 625 μl 5 18
    (a2) 100/1.3 rhIFNα 8 20 627 μl 5 18
    (a2) 150/0.4 rhIFNα 8 20 1257 μl 5 18
    (a2) 150/1.0 rhIFNα 8 20 623 μl 5 18
    (a2) 300/1.0 rhIFNα 1.6 20 6093 μl 5 18
    (a2)  30/1.0 rhEPO 6 20 750 μl 10 18
    (a2)  60/1.0 rhEPO 4.3 20 1043 μl 10 18
    (a2) 100/1.0 rhEPO 3.2 20 18.9 ml 10 18
    (a2) 150/1.0 rhEPO 1.8 20 2528 μl 10 18
  • TABLE 5
    Variation of the linker structure (example 18)
    HES HES HES:
    linker species target buffer system target [mg] target
    1 (a1) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.3 5.6:1 
    2 (a3) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 0.1 mg 10.4 40:1
    3 (a4) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    4 (a4) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 0.1 mg 2.7  8:1
    5 (a4) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 100 μg 4.3 20:1
    6 (a4) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 53 μg 5.2 30:1
    7 (a4) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 22.5 60:1
    8 (a4) 100/1.0 NH2-DNA 0.05M HEPES, pH 7 10 μg 5.5 60:1
    9 (a4) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 40 μg 2.6 50:1
    10 (a4) 100/1.0 hFab 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 50 μg 3.8 60:1
    11 (a4) 100/1.0 rhGH 0.1M Citrate, pH 6 0.1 mg 17 60:1
    12 (a4) 100/1.0 AmphoB 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5; 20 μg 83 60:1
    80% DMSO
    13 (a16) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    14 (a16) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 0.1 mg 2.7  8:1
    15 (a16) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 100 μg 8.6 40:1
    16 (a16) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 44 μg 4.3 30:1
    17 (a16) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 22.5 60:1
    18 (a16) 100/1.0 hFab 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 50 μg 3.8 60:1
    19 (a16) 100/1.0 rhGH 0.1M Citrate, pH 6 0.1 mg 18 60:1
    20 (a17) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    21 (a17) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 4 mg 513 60:1
    22 (a17) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 40 μg 2.6 50:1
    23 (a17) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 0.1 mg 22.5 60:1
    24 (a11) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    25 (a11) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 0.1 mg 2.7  8:1
    26 (a11) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 2 mg 173 40:1
    27 (a11) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 55 μg 5.4 30:1
    28 (a11) 100/1.0 rhGH 0.1M Citrate, pH 6 0.1 mg 18 60:1
    29 (a11) 100/1.0 hFab 0.1M NaOAc, pH 5 50 μg 3.8 60:1
    30 (a12) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    31 (a12) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 0.1M NaOAc pH 4 0.1 mg 2.7  8:1
    32 (a12) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 11 mg 478 20:1
    33 (a12) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 47 μg 4.6 30:1
    34 (a13) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    35 (a18) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    36 (a18) 100/1.0 rhEPO 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 4 mg 342 40:1
    37 (a5) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 12.1 5.6:1 
    38 (a14) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 54.3 25:1
    39 (a21) 100/1.0 Kemptide 0.1M NaOAc pH 5 30 μg 54.3 25:1
    target
    HES conc. NaCNBH3 rxn V rxn T rxn t
    linker species target HES % [g/l] [mM] [μl] [° C.] [h]
    1 (a1) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.49 20 61 5 18
    2 (a3) 100/1.0 rhEPO 30 2.9 20 35 10 18
    3 (a4) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    4 (a4) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 20 7.5 20 13 5 18
    5 (a4) 100/1.0 rhEPO 20 4.7 20 21 5 18
    6 (a4) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 15 1.5 20 35 10 18
    7 (a4) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 25 1.1 20 90 5 18
    8 (a4) 100/1.0 NH2-DNA 20 0.4 20 16 30 18
    9 (a4) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 7 1.1 20 39 10 18
    10 (a4) 100/1.0 hFab 20 2.7 20 19 5 18
    11 (a4) 100/1.0 rhGH 40 2.3 20 44 5 18
    12 (a4) 100/1.0 AmphoB 40 0.1 20 208 21 18
    13 (a16) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    14 (a16) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 20 7.5 20 13 5 18
    15 (a16) 100/1.0 rhEPO 30 3.5 20 29 5 18
    16 (a16) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 15 1.5 20 29 10 18
    17 (a16) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 25 1.1 20 90 5 18
    18 (a16) 100/1.0 hFab 20 2.7 20 19 5 18
    19 (a16) 100/1.0 rhGH 40 2.3 20 44 5 18
    20 (a17) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    21 (a17) 100/1.0 rhEPO 40 3.1 20 1284 5 18
    22 (a17) 100/1.0 rhFVIIa 6 0.9 20 43 10 18
    23 (a17) 100/1.0 rhLeptin 25 1.1 20 90 10 18
    24 (a11) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    25 (a11) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 20 7.5 20 13 5 18
    26 (a11) 100/1.0 rhEPO 30 3.5 20 579 5 18
    27 (a11) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 15 1.5 20 36 10 18
    28 (a11) 100/1.0 rhGH 40 2.3 20 44 5 18
    29 (a11) 100/1.0 hFab 20 2.7 20 19 5 18
    30 (a12) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    31 (a12) 100/1.0 rhIFNα 20 7.5 20 13 5 18
    32 (a12) 100/1.0 rhEPO 20 4.6 20 2389 5 18
    33 (a12) 100/1.0 rhG-CSF 15 1.5 20 31 10 18
    34 (a13) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    35 (a18) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    36 (a18) 100/1.0 EPO 30 3.5 20 1141 5 18
    37 (a5) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.5 20 61 5 18
    38 (a14) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.1 20 271 5 18
    39 (a21) 100/1.0 Kemptide 20 0.1 20 271 25 18
  • Additional Data
  • (A.1) Preparation of oxHBS-N-(3-Propioaldehydediethylacetal) from HBS 7 kDa
  • Hyper branched starch (HBS) aldonic acid was synthesized according to example 9 of WO2005/083103 A1 starting from a hyperbranched starch (Mw=7000 Dalton (7 kDa), average degree of branching: 15 mol %). The aldonic acid obtained was transferred into the corresponding lactone by drying for 24 h at 80° C. (the abbreviation “oxHBS” refers to the HBS aldonic acid as well as to the corresponding lactone).
  • 5 g of the lactone were dissolved in 15 ml 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane and 10 ml of dry DMF and stirred at 70° C. for 48 h. Excess 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane and DMF (dimethylformamide) were evaporated under vacuum and the resulting pale yellow solid was washed with acetone until the yellow colour disappeared. The product was dissolved in water and purified by ultrafiltration utilizing a membrane with a cut-off of 1000 Dalton until the pH of the filtrate reached a value of >6.
  • The retentate was treated with 2 g of an acidic cation exchange resign (Amberlite® 120) for 2 h, the resign was filtered off and the remaining solution lyophilized.
  • The 1H-NMR Spectrum of the compound showed a triplett at 1.7 and a multiplett at 1.2 ppm representing the methyl- and the methylene groups in alpha-position to the nitrogen atom of the residue of the linker compound (1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane).
  • (A.2) Preparation of oxHBS 7 kDa—Bovine Serum Albumin (BSA) conjugate
  • 750 μg of acetal prepared in (A.1) were dissolved in 5 ml 0.01N HCl. The pH was adjusted to 2.0 with 1 N HCl, and the reaction mixture was stirred at 21° C. for 18 h. 2 ml of a 1% BSA solution in acetate buffer (pH=7.0) were added to 200 μl of the mixture prepared before. 140 mg sodium cyanoborohydride were dissolved in 5 ml 0.1 N acetate buffer (pH=7.0), and an aliquot of 50 ml was added to the reaction mixture immediately. The reaction mixture was stored at 4° C. for 15 h. Analysis of the reaction mixture by size-exclusion chromatography revealed a reaction yield of 90% HBS-BSA conjugate. (FIG. 24)
  • (A.3) Preparation of oxHBS 65 kDa—Interferon-Alpha Conjugate
  • To 400 mg of a 65 kDa HBS-N-(3-propioaldehydediethylacetal) prepared analogously to (A.1) an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v) and a pH value of 2. The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. o/n (overnight) to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH prior to coupling.
  • Interferon-alpha (recombinant human interferon alpha-2b manufactured by recombinant DNA technology using Escherichia coli (E. coli), the interferon alpha-2b being composed of 165 amino acids and presenting an amino acid sequence which is identical to natural human interferon alpha-2b (hIFN-alpha-2b)) was concentrated up to 16 mg/ml and transferred into a suitable conjugation buffer (0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 4.0) using ultrafiltration devices.
  • A 10fold molar excess of oxHBS aldehyde (based on Mw) was used with a final protein concentration in the reaction mixture of 6 mg/ml; the oxHBS aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The deprotected oxHBS aldehyde was combined with the protein solution and to the reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a freshly prepared NaCNBH3 solution (0.5 M in conjugation buffer) to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • The reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 25) and reversed phase chromatography on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.
  • The HBS-Interferon-alpha was separated from non-reacted compounds by anion-exchange chromatography using a Q HP column on an Äkta system (GE Healthcare). Eluent A was 10 mM Tris•Cl, pH 8.0, Eluent B was 10 mM Tris•Cl, 0.5 M NaCl, pH 8.0. The gradient for separation of conjugate and non-modified protein was 0% B=>50% B in 16 CV (FIG. 26).
  • (A.4) Preparation of oxHBS 65 Erythropoietin (EPO) Conjugate
  • To 400 mg of a 65 kDa HBS-N-(3-propioaldehydediethylacetal) prepared analogously to (A.1) an appropriate amount of 10 mM HCl was added to yield a solution with a concentration of 40% (w/v). The solution was incubated under stirring at 21° C. o/n to deprotect the aldehyde function. The pH-value was adjusted to the value used in the conjugation buffer by addition of 0.1 M NaOH.
  • The deprotected oxHBS aldehyde was combined with an EPO (recombinant human EPO having the amino acid sequence of human EPO and essentially the same characteristics as the commercially available Erypo® (Ortho Biotech, Jansen-Cilag) or NeoRecormon® (Roche)) solution (10 mg/ml in the reaction buffer 0.1 M sodium acetate buffer, pH 5). OxHBS aldehyde was added at a 20fold molar excess (based on Mw) compared to the EPO concentration. The resulting EPO concentration in the reaction mix was 4.6 mg/ml, the oxHBS aldehyde concentration was 20% (w/v). The reductive amination reaction was started by addition of a 0.5 M NaCNBH3 solution made up in reaction buffer to yield a final concentration of reducing agent of 20 mM. After thorough mixing, the reaction was incubated o/n at 10° C.
  • The reaction mixtures were analyzed by SDS-PAGE (FIG. 27) and reversed phase chromatography (FIG. A.4-1) on a C18 column (Phenomenex, Jupiter) to prove successful coupling and for determination of the conjugation yield. Elution was carried out using an acidic water/acetonitrile gradient with 0.1% TFA.

Claims (25)

1. A method for the preparation of a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative, comprising
(i) reacting hydroxyalkyl starch (HAS) of formula (I)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00099
via carbon atom C* of the reducing end of the HAS with the amino group M of a crosslinking compound according to formula (II)

M-L-A  (II)
wherein A is an acetal group or a ketal group; and L is a spacer bridging M and A, wherein C* is optionally oxidised prior to the reaction of HAS with M,
obtaining a HAS derivative according to formula (III)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00100
wherein X is the functional group resulting from the reaction of the amino group M with the HAS via carbon atom C* of the optionally oxidised reducing end of the HAS, and
wherein HAS′ is the remainder of the hydroxyalkyl starch molecule, and R1, R2 and R3 are independently hydrogen or a linear or branched hydroxyalkyl group.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein R1, R2 and R3 are independently a group —(CH2CH2O)n—H, wherein n is an integer, preferably 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
3. The method of claim 1, wherein the hydroxyalkyl starch is hydroxyethyl starch (HES).
4. The method of claim 1, wherein A is a residue according to formula (IIa)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00101
wherein
Z1 and Z2 are each independently O or S or NRx, preferably O, wherein Rx is H or lower alkyl such as methyl, ethyl, or propyl such as n-propyl or i-propyl, or C(O)—Ry wherein Ry is preferably selected from the group consisting of C1-C6 alkyl and C6-C14 aryl, even more preferably selected from the group consisting of optionally substituted, preferably non-substituted methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, and tert-butyl; Rx preferably being H;
A1 and A2 are each independently methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, tert-butyl, benzyl, 1,1,1-trichloroethyl, nitrobenzyl, methoxybenzyl, ethoxybenzyl, or are forming a ring according to formula (IIb)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00102
wherein A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2— or —(CH2)3— or —(CH2CH(CH3))—, and
wherein A3 is H or methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, pentyl, benzyl, or is forming a ring with the N atom of the amino group M or with a suitable atom comprised in L, A3 preferably being H.
5. The method of claim 4, wherein Z1 and Z2 are each O; A3 is H; and wherein A1 and A2 are each ethyl or wherein A1 and A2 are forming a ring according to formula (IIb) wherein A1 and A2, taken together, are —(CH2)2—.
6. The method of claim 1, wherein the amino group M is a group according to formula (IIc)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00103
wherein Y is either absent or is a chemical moiety selected from the group consisting of
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00104
wherein G is O or S or NH, and, if present twice, each G is independently O or S or NH, O being preferred, and
wherein R′ is H or a hydroxy group or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, and substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl.
7. The method of claim 1, wherein the amino group M is H2N—, H2N—O—, H2N—NH—(C═O)—, H3C—NH— or H3C—NH—O—, preferably H2N—, H2N—O—, or H2N—NH—(C═O)—.
8. The method of claim 1, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted via its oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 80° C., and wherein X is —(C═O)—NH—.
9. The method of claim 1, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 20 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4 to 7, X being —CH═N—.
10. The method of claim 9, wherein in (i), the reaction is carried out in the presence of a reductive agent, preferably NaCNBH3, to obtain a HAS derivative, X being —CH2—NH—.
11. The method of claim 1, wherein in (i), HAS is reacted, preferably in an aqueous system, via its non-oxidised reducing end with the amino group M of the crosslinking compound, M being H2N—O— or H2N—NH—(C═O)—, and wherein the reaction is carried out at a temperature in the range of from 5 to 80° C. at a pH in the range of from 4.5 to 6.5, X being —CH═N—O— or —CH═N—NH—(C═O)—.
12. The method of claim 1, wherein L bridging M and A is a spacer comprising at least one structural unit according to formula (IId), preferably consisting of a structural unit according to formula (IId)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00105
wherein L1 and L2 are independently from each other H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl, and residues —O—R″ wherein R″ is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, substituted alkyl, alkenyl, substituted alkenyl, alkynyl, substituted alkynyl, aryl, substituted aryl, arylalkyl, substituted arylalkyl, alkylaryl, substituted alkylaryl; preferably H or an organic residue selected from the group consisting of alkyl and substituted alkyl; more preferably H or alkyl; more preferably H,
wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 6, more preferably from 1 to 4, more preferably 2.
13. The method of claim 1, wherein L is —(CL1L2)n-, preferably —(CH2)n—, wherein n is an integer from 1 to 20, preferably from 1 to 10, and wherein, more preferably, L is —CH2—CH2—.
14. The method of claim 1, wherein L comprises at least one structure unit —(CL1L2)n1-O—(CL1L2)n2-, preferably —(CH2)n1—O—(CH2)n2 wherein n1 is equal to or different from n2, and wherein the spacer L is preferably linked via —(CL1L2)n1- to the amino group M of the crosslinking compound.
15. The method of claim 14, wherein L is —((CL1L2-O)m—(CL1L2)—, preferably —((CH2)2—O)m—CH2—, wherein m is 1, 2, or 3, more preferably 2 or 3.
16. The method of any of claim 1, wherein L is —(CL1L2)n-(C═O)—NH—(CL1L2)n-, preferably —(CH2)n—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)n—, wherein each n is, independently from each other, preferably in the range of from 1 to 4, more preferably in the range of from 1 to 3.
17. The method of claim 16, wherein L is selected from the group consisting of
—(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)3—; —(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—;
—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)3—; and —(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—;
most preferably selected from the group consisting of
—(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—; and —(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—.
18. The method of claim 1, wherein the crosslinking compound M-L-A according to formula (II) is selected from the group consisting of
H2N—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)2—O—(CH2)2—O—CH2—CH(OCH2CH3)2,
H2N—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)7—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—O—(CH2)2—O—(CH2)2—O—CH2—CH(OCH2CH3)2; and
H2N—NH—(C═O)—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
preferably from the group consisting of
H2N—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)2—O—(CH2)2—O—CH2—CH(OCH2CH3)2,
H2N—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—O—(CH2)2—O—(CH2)2—O—CH2—CH(OCH2CH3)2; and
H2N—NH—(C═O)—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
and more preferably from the group consisting of
H2N—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2;
H2N—(CH2)2—O—(CH2)2—O—CH2—CH(OCH2CH3)2,
H2N—(CH2)2—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2; and
H2N—(CH2)3—(C═O)—NH—(CH2)2—CH(OCH2CH3)2.
19. The method of claim 1, wherein the crosslinking compound M-L-A according to formula (II) is 1-amino-3,3-diethoxypropane.
20. The method of claim 1, further comprising
(ii) reacting the HAS derivative according to formula (III) via group A with an amino group of a biologically active agent H2N-BA′, via reductive amination, obtaining a HAS derivative according to formula (IV)
Figure US20130230898A1-20130905-C00106
21. The method of claim 20, wherein prior to (ii), group A of the HAS derivative according to formula (III) is transformed to the corresponding aldehyde or keto group.
22. The method of claim 20, wherein in (ii), the reaction is carried out, preferably in an aqueous system, in the presence of a reducing agent, preferably NaCNBH3, at a temperature in the range of from 0 to 37° C., preferably 0 to 25° C. and a pH in the range of from 3 to 9, preferably from 3 to 7, more preferably from 3 to below 7, and wherein in (ii), the molar ratio of the HAS derivative to the biologically active agent H2N-BA′ is from 0.1:1 to 200:1 equivalents, preferably from 1:1 to 50:1 equivalents, based on the number average molecular weight (Mn) of the HAS derivative.
23. The method of claim 20, wherein the biologically active agent H2N-BA′ is a peptide, an oligopeptide, a polypeptide, a protein, a functional derivative, fragment or mimetic of the polypeptide or protein, a small molecule compound or an oligonucleotide.
24. The method of claim 23, wherein the protein is erythropoietin (EPO) such as recombinant human EPO (rhEPO), a colony-stimulating factor (CSF) such as G-CSF like recombinant human G-CSF (rhG-CSF), interferon (IFN) such as IFN alpha, IFN beta, IFN gamma like recombinant human IFN alpha (rhIFN alpha) or recombinant human IFN beta (rhIFN beta), factor VII such as recombinant human factor VIIa (rhFVIIa), factor IX such as recombinant human factor IX (rhFIX), growth hormone (GH) such as recombinant human growth hormone (rhGH), Fab fragments such as Fab fragment derived from human immunoglobuline G molecule (hFab), immunoglobuline G such as murine immunoglobuline G (mIgG), glucagon-like peptide-1 (GLP-1), asparaginase such as recombinant asparaginase (rAsparaginase), leptin such as recombinant human leptin (rhLeptin), interleukine-2, interleukine-11, alpha-1-antitrypsin, an antibody, or an antibody fragment, or an alternative protein scaffold.
25.-51. (canceled)
US13/770,275 2007-12-14 2013-02-19 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation Abandoned US20130230898A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US13/770,275 US20130230898A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2013-02-19 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP07024350A EP2070950A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2007-12-14 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
EP07024350.6 2007-12-14
PCT/EP2008/010660 WO2009077154A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2008-12-15 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
US74798110A 2010-07-12 2010-07-12
US13/770,275 US20130230898A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2013-02-19 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation

Related Parent Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/EP2008/010660 Division WO2009077154A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2008-12-15 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
US74798110A Division 2007-12-14 2010-07-12

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20130230898A1 true US20130230898A1 (en) 2013-09-05

Family

ID=39345136

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/747,981 Expired - Fee Related US8404834B2 (en) 2007-12-14 2008-12-15 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
US13/770,275 Abandoned US20130230898A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2013-02-19 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/747,981 Expired - Fee Related US8404834B2 (en) 2007-12-14 2008-12-15 Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation

Country Status (15)

Country Link
US (2) US8404834B2 (en)
EP (2) EP2070950A1 (en)
JP (1) JP5486507B2 (en)
KR (1) KR101578955B1 (en)
CN (1) CN101918455B (en)
AU (1) AU2008337931B2 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0821133A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2707811A1 (en)
EA (1) EA018222B1 (en)
ES (1) ES2399003T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1144780A1 (en)
IL (1) IL206223A (en)
NZ (1) NZ586021A (en)
WO (1) WO2009077154A1 (en)
ZA (1) ZA201004220B (en)

Families Citing this family (22)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DE10209822A1 (en) 2002-03-06 2003-09-25 Biotechnologie Ges Mittelhesse Coupling of low molecular weight substances to a modified polysaccharide
DE10209821A1 (en) 2002-03-06 2003-09-25 Biotechnologie Ges Mittelhesse Coupling of proteins to a modified polysaccharide
BR0314107A (en) 2002-09-11 2005-07-19 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh Production method of hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives
WO2005014655A2 (en) 2003-08-08 2005-02-17 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein
WO2005092391A2 (en) * 2004-03-11 2005-10-06 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein
AR048035A1 (en) 2004-03-11 2006-03-22 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh CONJUGADOS DE ALMIDON DE HIDROXIALQUILO AND A PROTEIN, PREPARED BY REDUCING AMINATION
EP1762250A1 (en) * 2005-09-12 2007-03-14 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and an active substance, prepared by chemical ligation via thiazolidine
EP2070950A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2009-06-17 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
RU2011110459A (en) 2008-08-21 2012-09-27 Октафарма АГ (CH) RECOMBINANTLY OBTAINED HUMAN FACTOR VIII AND IX
WO2010033240A2 (en) 2008-09-19 2010-03-25 Nektar Therapeutics Carbohydrate-based drug delivery polymers and conjugates thereof
WO2011035065A1 (en) * 2009-09-17 2011-03-24 Nektar Therapeutics Monoconjugated chitosans as delivery agents for small interfering nucleic acids
ES2545893T3 (en) 2010-04-20 2015-09-16 Octapharma Ag New stabilizing agent for pharmaceutical proteins
EP2591008A1 (en) * 2010-07-09 2013-05-15 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH Conjugates comprising hydroxyalkyl starch and a cytotoxic agent and process for their preparation
LT2809329T (en) * 2012-01-30 2018-12-10 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh Hydroxyalkyl starch in combination with cytostatica for the treatment of cancers by reduction of tumor growth rates
PL228735B1 (en) * 2012-02-27 2018-04-30 Inst Immunologii I Terapii Doswiadczalnej Pan A conjugate comprising a carrier and covalently tied with the drug and the use thereof
RU2497828C1 (en) * 2012-06-22 2013-11-10 Федеральное Государственное Бюджетное Учреждение Науки Институт Химии Коми Научного Центра Уральского Отделения Российской Академии Наук Hydrophilic conjugate of hydroxyethyl starch and 2,6-diisobornyl-4-methylphenol
WO2014147175A1 (en) * 2013-03-20 2014-09-25 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives as reactants for coupling to thiol groups
WO2014200344A1 (en) * 2013-06-13 2014-12-18 Coöperatie Avebe U.A. Starch-based aqueous adhesive compositions and uses thereof.
CN103554283B (en) * 2013-10-10 2016-09-14 西北大学 Functional starch containing dopamine and Polyethylene Glycol and its preparation method and application
KR101702870B1 (en) * 2015-08-31 2017-02-06 한림대학교 산학협력단 Synthetic method for (-)-pinidinone
CN105418754A (en) * 2015-09-30 2016-03-23 天津药物研究院有限公司 Hydroxyethyl starch modified hemopoietin mimic peptide and preparation thereof and application thereof
CN110256069B (en) * 2019-06-25 2021-11-30 济南大学 Preparation method of photo-curable dyed dental zirconia ceramic slurry for 3D printing and forming

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7129327B2 (en) * 1986-04-30 2006-10-31 Amylin Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Polypeptide and protein derivatives and process for their preparation

Family Cites Families (135)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3191291A (en) * 1959-01-21 1965-06-29 Continental Can Co Art of producing very thin steel and like sheets in wide strips
NL269801A (en) * 1960-10-04 1964-03-10 Farbwerke Höchst Ag PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF WATER-INSOLUBLE DYES
GB1385403A (en) * 1971-07-14 1975-02-26 Unilever Ltd Process for preparing oxidised carbohydrates
GB1419080A (en) 1972-12-29 1975-12-24 Cheminova As Chemical compounds having juvenile hormone activity
US4179337A (en) * 1973-07-20 1979-12-18 Davis Frank F Non-immunogenic polypeptides
US4125492A (en) * 1974-05-31 1978-11-14 Pedro Cuatrecasas Affinity chromatography of vibrio cholerae enterotoxin-ganglioside polysaccharide and the biological effects of ganglioside-containing soluble polymers
US4001200A (en) 1975-02-27 1977-01-04 Alza Corporation Novel polymerized, cross-linked, stromal-free hemoglobin
CA1055932A (en) 1975-10-22 1979-06-05 Hematech Inc. Blood substitute based on hemoglobin
DE2616086C2 (en) 1976-04-13 1986-04-03 Dr. Eduard Fresenius, Chemisch-pharmazeutische Industrie KG, 6380 Bad Homburg Substance for use in a colloidal blood volume substitute made from hydroxyethyl starch and hemoglobin
GB1578348A (en) * 1976-08-17 1980-11-05 Pharmacia Ab Products and a method for the therapeutic suppression of reaginic antibodies responsible for common allergic
FR2378094A2 (en) 1977-01-24 1978-08-18 Inst Nat Sante Rech Med Biological reagent for diagnosis of specific illnesses - having an oxidised gluco-protein antibody on an insoluble support
EP0019403B1 (en) 1979-05-10 1985-07-31 American Hospital Supply Corporation Hydroxyalkyl-starch drug carrier
DE3029307A1 (en) 1980-08-01 1982-03-04 Dr. Eduard Fresenius, Chemisch-pharmazeutische Industrie KG, 6380 Bad Homburg Blood substitute with oxygen transport properties - produced by coupling of a polysaccharide e.g. dextran with cell-free haemoglobin
US4454161A (en) 1981-02-07 1984-06-12 Kabushiki Kaisha Hayashibara Seibutsu Kagaku Kenkyujo Process for the production of branching enzyme, and a method for improving the qualities of food products therewith
JPS57206622A (en) * 1981-06-10 1982-12-18 Ajinomoto Co Inc Blood substitute
FI82266C (en) 1982-10-19 1991-02-11 Cetus Corp Process for Preparation of IL-2 Mutein
EP0127839B1 (en) 1983-05-27 1992-07-15 THE TEXAS A&M UNIVERSITY SYSTEM Method for producing a recombinant baculovirus expression vector
IN163192B (en) 1983-10-11 1988-08-20 Fidia Spa
NZ210501A (en) 1983-12-13 1991-08-27 Kirin Amgen Inc Erythropoietin produced by procaryotic or eucaryotic expression of an exogenous dna sequence
US4703008A (en) * 1983-12-13 1987-10-27 Kiren-Amgen, Inc. DNA sequences encoding erythropoietin
US4952496A (en) * 1984-03-30 1990-08-28 Associated Universities, Inc. Cloning and expression of the gene for bacteriophage T7 RNA polymerase
IL77081A (en) 1984-12-04 1999-10-28 Genetics Inst Dna sequence encoding human erythropoietin process for the preparation thereof and a pharmaceutical composition of human erythropoietin
DE3501616A1 (en) 1985-01-17 1986-07-17 Schering AG, 1000 Berlin und 4709 Bergkamen Process for the preparation of hydroxylamine derivatives
US4667016A (en) * 1985-06-20 1987-05-19 Kirin-Amgen, Inc. Erythropoietin purification
US4766106A (en) * 1985-06-26 1988-08-23 Cetus Corporation Solubilization of proteins for pharmaceutical compositions using polymer conjugation
US4863964A (en) 1985-07-02 1989-09-05 Biomedical Frontiers, Inc. Method for the stabilization of deferoxamine to chelate free ions in physiological fluid
US5217998A (en) 1985-07-02 1993-06-08 Biomedical Frontiers, Inc. Composition for the stabilization of deferoxamine to chelate free ions in physiological fluid
DD279486A1 (en) 1986-03-10 1990-06-06 Akad Wissenschaften Ddr PROCESS FOR ACTIVATING HYDROXYL GROUP-CONTAINING POLYMER COMPOUNDS
GB8610551D0 (en) 1986-04-30 1986-06-04 Hoffmann La Roche Polypeptide & protein derivatives
IT1203814B (en) 1986-06-30 1989-02-23 Fidia Farmaceutici ESTERS OF ALGINIC ACID
FR2600894B1 (en) * 1986-07-02 1989-01-13 Centre Nat Rech Scient MACROMOLECULAR CONJUGATES OF HEMOGLOBIN, THEIR PREPARATION PROCESS AND THEIR APPLICATIONS
US5362853A (en) * 1986-12-23 1994-11-08 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Polypeptide derivatives of human granulocyte colony stimulating factor
US5214132A (en) * 1986-12-23 1993-05-25 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Polypeptide derivatives of human granulocyte colony stimulating factor
EP0307827A3 (en) 1987-09-15 1989-12-27 Kuraray Co., Ltd. Novel macromolecular complexes, process for producing same and medicinal use of such complexes
IL84252A (en) 1987-10-23 1994-02-27 Yissum Res Dev Co Phospholipase inhibiting compositions
US4904584A (en) * 1987-12-23 1990-02-27 Genetics Institute, Inc. Site-specific homogeneous modification of polypeptides
US4847325A (en) * 1988-01-20 1989-07-11 Cetus Corporation Conjugation of polymer to colony stimulating factor-1
DK110188D0 (en) 1988-03-02 1988-03-02 Claus Selch Larsen HIGH MOLECULAR WEIGHT PRODRUG DERIVATIVES OF ANTI-FLAMMATORY DRUGS
FR2630329B1 (en) * 1988-04-20 1991-07-05 Merieux Inst MACROMOLECULAR CONJUGATES OF HEMOGLOBIN, THEIR PREPARATION PROCESS AND THEIR APPLICATIONS
IT1219942B (en) 1988-05-13 1990-05-24 Fidia Farmaceutici POLYSACCHARIDIC ESTERS
US4900780A (en) * 1988-05-25 1990-02-13 Masonic Medical Research Laboratory Acellular resuscitative fluid
US4925677A (en) * 1988-08-31 1990-05-15 Theratech, Inc. Biodegradable hydrogel matrices for the controlled release of pharmacologically active agents
US5420105A (en) * 1988-09-23 1995-05-30 Gustavson; Linda M. Polymeric carriers for non-covalent drug conjugation
US5218092A (en) * 1988-09-29 1993-06-08 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Modified granulocyte-colony stimulating factor polypeptide with added carbohydrate chains
DE3836600A1 (en) * 1988-10-27 1990-05-03 Wolff Walsrode Ag CARBONIC ESTERES OF POLYSACCHARIDES AND METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF
ATE135370T1 (en) * 1988-12-22 1996-03-15 Kirin Amgen Inc CHEMICALLY MODIFIED GRANULOCYTE COLONY EXCITING FACTOR
US6261800B1 (en) * 1989-05-05 2001-07-17 Genentech, Inc. Luteinizing hormone/choriogonadotropin (LH/CG) receptor
DE3919729C3 (en) * 1989-06-16 1997-06-19 Fresenius Ag Hydroxyethyl starch as a plasma expander, process for their preparation and use as a colloidal plasma substitute
NL8902128A (en) 1989-08-23 1991-03-18 Avebe Coop Verkoop Prod BRANCHING ENZYME AND USE THEREOF.
JP2896580B2 (en) 1989-08-25 1999-05-31 チッソ株式会社 Amylose-lysozyme hybrid, activated sugar and its production
WO1991005867A1 (en) 1989-10-13 1991-05-02 Amgen Inc. Erythropoietin isoforms
US5169784A (en) 1990-09-17 1992-12-08 The Texas A & M University System Baculovirus dual promoter expression vector
DK130991D0 (en) * 1991-07-04 1991-07-04 Immunodex K S POLYMER CONJUGATES
US5281698A (en) * 1991-07-23 1994-01-25 Cetus Oncology Corporation Preparation of an activated polymer ester for protein conjugation
DE4130807A1 (en) * 1991-09-17 1993-03-18 Wolff Walsrode Ag METHOD FOR PRODUCING POLYSACCHARIDE CARBONATES
US6172208B1 (en) * 1992-07-06 2001-01-09 Genzyme Corporation Oligonucleotides modified with conjugate groups
GB2270920B (en) * 1992-09-25 1997-04-02 Univ Keele Alginate-bioactive agent conjugates
NZ250375A (en) 1992-12-09 1995-07-26 Ortho Pharma Corp Peg hydrazone and peg oxime linkage forming reagents and protein derivatives
CA2110543A1 (en) 1992-12-09 1994-06-10 David E. Wright Peg hydrazone and peg oxime linkage forming reagents and protein derivatives thereof
EP0601417A3 (en) * 1992-12-11 1998-07-01 Hoechst Aktiengesellschaft Physiologically compatible and degradable polymer-based carbohydrate receptor blockers, a method for their preparation and their use
US5581476A (en) * 1993-01-28 1996-12-03 Amgen Inc. Computer-based methods and articles of manufacture for preparing G-CSF analogs
AU668294B2 (en) 1993-03-16 1996-04-26 Hemosol Inc. Selective crosslinking of hemoglobins by oxidized, ring-opened saccharides
WO1994028024A1 (en) 1993-06-01 1994-12-08 Enzon, Inc. Carbohydrate-modified polymer conjugates with erythropoietic activity
IL110669A (en) 1993-08-17 2008-11-26 Kirin Amgen Inc Erythropoietin analogs
US5840900A (en) * 1993-10-20 1998-11-24 Enzon, Inc. High molecular weight polymer-based prodrugs
US5876980A (en) * 1995-04-11 1999-03-02 Cytel Corporation Enzymatic synthesis of oligosaccharides
US6214331B1 (en) * 1995-06-06 2001-04-10 C. R. Bard, Inc. Process for the preparation of aqueous dispersions of particles of water-soluble polymers and the particles obtained
WO1996040662A2 (en) * 1995-06-07 1996-12-19 Cellpro, Incorporated Aminooxy-containing linker compounds and their application in conjugates
US5736533A (en) * 1995-06-07 1998-04-07 Neose Technologies, Inc. Bacterial inhibition with an oligosaccharide compound
US5981507A (en) * 1995-12-14 1999-11-09 Advanced Magnetics, Inc. Polymeric carriers linked to nucleotide analogues via a phosphoramide bond
US5723589A (en) * 1995-12-21 1998-03-03 Icn Pharmaceuticals Carbohydrate conjugated bio-active compounds
JP2000506119A (en) 1996-02-15 2000-05-23 ノボ ノルディスク アクティーゼルスカブ Conjugation of polypeptides
US5717998A (en) * 1996-03-07 1998-02-17 Everett; Betty L. Swimsuit with displaceable crotch
US5696152A (en) 1996-05-07 1997-12-09 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Taxol composition for use as organ preservation and cardioplegic agents
TW517067B (en) 1996-05-31 2003-01-11 Hoffmann La Roche Interferon conjugates
DE19628705A1 (en) 1996-07-08 1998-01-15 Fresenius Ag New oxygen transport agents, hemoglobin-hydroxyethyl starch conjugates containing them, processes for their preparation and their use as blood substitutes
US5770645A (en) * 1996-08-02 1998-06-23 Duke University Medical Center Polymers for delivering nitric oxide in vivo
US6011008A (en) * 1997-01-08 2000-01-04 Yissum Research Developement Company Of The Hebrew University Of Jerusalem Conjugates of biologically active substances
US5952347A (en) * 1997-03-13 1999-09-14 Merck & Co., Inc. Quinoline leukotriene antagonists
US6299881B1 (en) * 1997-03-24 2001-10-09 Henry M. Jackson Foundation For The Advancement Of Military Medicine Uronium salts for activating hydroxyls, carboxyls, and polysaccharides, and conjugate vaccines, immunogens, and other useful immunological reagents produced using uronium salts
US5990237A (en) 1997-05-21 1999-11-23 Shearwater Polymers, Inc. Poly(ethylene glycol) aldehyde hydrates and related polymers and applications in modifying amines
DE69825288D1 (en) * 1997-08-07 2004-09-02 Univ Utah PRODRUGS AND CONJUGATES OF SELENOL-CONTAINING COMPOUNDS AND THEIR USE
US6875594B2 (en) * 1997-11-13 2005-04-05 The Rockefeller University Methods of ligating expressed proteins
US6624142B2 (en) * 1997-12-30 2003-09-23 Enzon, Inc. Trimethyl lock based tetrapartate prodrugs
DE19808079A1 (en) 1998-02-20 1999-08-26 Schering Ag New hydroxyethyl starch conjugates useful as X-ray, NMR and blood-pool diagnostic agents, e.g. for diagnosis of tumors, cardiovascular disorders and inflammation
CA2233725A1 (en) * 1998-03-31 1999-09-30 Hemosol Inc. Hemoglobin-hydroxyethyl starch complexes
US6153655A (en) * 1998-04-17 2000-11-28 Enzon, Inc. Terminally-branched polymeric linkers and polymeric conjugates containing the same
FR2783838B1 (en) 1998-09-25 2000-12-01 Roquette Freres PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF A MIXTURE OF STARCH BRANCHING ENZYMES EXTRACTED FROM ALGAE
US6261594B1 (en) * 1998-11-25 2001-07-17 The University Of Akron Chitosan-based nitric oxide donor compositions
EP1035137A1 (en) * 1999-03-12 2000-09-13 Pasteur Merieux Serums Et Vaccins Method for the reductive amination of polysaccharides
FR2792941B1 (en) 1999-04-30 2001-07-27 Roquette Freres SOLUBLE BRANCHED GLUCOSE POLYMERS AND PROCESS FOR OBTAINING SAME
US7279176B1 (en) * 1999-09-02 2007-10-09 Rice University Nitric oxide-producing hydrogel materials
US20020065410A1 (en) 1999-12-02 2002-05-30 Antrim Richard L. Branched starches and branched starch hydrolyzates
US6555660B2 (en) * 2000-01-10 2003-04-29 Maxygen Holdings Ltd. G-CSF conjugates
US6586398B1 (en) * 2000-04-07 2003-07-01 Amgen, Inc. Chemically modified novel erythropoietin stimulating protein compositions and methods
JP2001294601A (en) 2000-04-11 2001-10-23 Akita Prefecture Highly branched starch and method for producing the same
JP2002003398A (en) 2000-04-17 2002-01-09 Ltt Institute Co Ltd Sustained-release preparation, method for preparing the same, and vaccine therefrom
US6417347B1 (en) * 2000-08-24 2002-07-09 Scimed Life Systems, Inc. High yield S-nitrosylation process
DE10041541A1 (en) 2000-08-24 2002-03-14 Michael Duchene New nucleic acid encoding moth allergens, related polypeptides and antibodies, useful in the diagnosis and treatment of arthropod allergies
DE10105921A1 (en) 2001-02-09 2002-08-14 Braun Melsungen Ag Active pharmaceutical ingredients bound to colloids
DE10112825A1 (en) * 2001-03-16 2002-10-02 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh HESylation of active ingredients in aqueous solution
DE10126158A1 (en) 2001-05-30 2002-12-12 Novira Chem Gmbh Mixtures of alpha-hydroxy-omega-alkoxy- and alpha-omega-dialkoxy-polyoxyalkylene containing little or no dihydroxy-polyoxyalkylene, used for coupling and modification of proteins and other bioactive molecules
DE10129369C1 (en) 2001-06-21 2003-03-06 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh Water soluble antibiotic in the form of a polysaccharide conjugate containing an aminosugar
DE10135694A1 (en) 2001-07-21 2003-02-06 Supramol Parenteral Colloids New amphiphilic conjugate of starch or hydroxyethylstarch, useful as drug carrier, contain e.g. fatty acyl residues, are not taken up by the reticuloendothelial system
US7125843B2 (en) * 2001-10-19 2006-10-24 Neose Technologies, Inc. Glycoconjugates including more than one peptide
US7179617B2 (en) * 2001-10-10 2007-02-20 Neose Technologies, Inc. Factor IX: remolding and glycoconjugation of Factor IX
US6375846B1 (en) * 2001-11-01 2002-04-23 Harry Wellington Jarrett Cyanogen bromide-activation of hydroxyls on silica for high pressure affinity chromatography
DE10155098A1 (en) 2001-11-09 2003-05-22 Supramol Parenteral Colloids Agent for protecting cell and tissue cultures against fungi, comprises water-soluble conjugate of polyene macrolide and polysaccharide
AU2002357806A1 (en) 2001-12-11 2003-06-23 Sun Bio, Inc. Novel monofunctional polyethylene glycol aldehydes
US6956135B2 (en) 2001-12-11 2005-10-18 Sun Bio, Inc. Monofunctional polyethylene glycol aldehydes
US6916962B2 (en) 2001-12-11 2005-07-12 Sun Bio, Inc. Monofunctional polyethylene glycol aldehydes
DE10209822A1 (en) 2002-03-06 2003-09-25 Biotechnologie Ges Mittelhesse Coupling of low molecular weight substances to a modified polysaccharide
DE10209821A1 (en) 2002-03-06 2003-09-25 Biotechnologie Ges Mittelhesse Coupling of proteins to a modified polysaccharide
AU2003221291A1 (en) 2002-03-13 2003-09-22 Beijing Jiankai Technology Co., Ltd. Hydrophilic polymer derivate with y type branch and preparation method of it medical composite comprising above compound
JP2003314520A (en) * 2002-04-12 2003-11-06 Kramski Gmbh Cylindrical pin
DE10217994A1 (en) 2002-04-23 2003-11-06 Supramol Parenteral Colloids A coupling product from (sic) chemical compounds of hyperbranched polysaccharide completely catabolized in the body under control of the body enzymes useful for parenteral pharmaceutically active materials
US20040101546A1 (en) 2002-11-26 2004-05-27 Gorman Anne Jessica Hemostatic wound dressing containing aldehyde-modified polysaccharide and hemostatic agents
EP1591467A1 (en) 2002-09-09 2005-11-02 Nektar Therapeutics Al, Corporation Conjugate between a polyethylene glycol having a terminal alkanal group and a human growth hormone
RS20050202A (en) 2002-09-09 2007-08-03 Nektar Therapeuticals Al.Corporation, Water-soluble polymer alkanals
EP1400533A1 (en) * 2002-09-11 2004-03-24 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH HASylated polypeptides, especially HASylated erythropoietin
DE10242076A1 (en) * 2002-09-11 2004-03-25 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh New covalently bonded conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch with allergens, useful as modified allergens with depot effect for use in specific immunotherapy for combating allergies, e.g. hay fever
BR0314107A (en) 2002-09-11 2005-07-19 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh Production method of hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives
DE10254745A1 (en) 2002-11-23 2004-06-03 Supramol Parenteral Colloids Gmbh New aldonic acid imidazolides of starch compounds selectively oxidized at the reducing terminal, useful for coupling with amino functions of pharmaceutically active agents, e.g. proteins
DE10256558A1 (en) 2002-12-04 2004-09-16 Supramol Parenteral Colloids Gmbh Esters of polysaccharide aldonic acids, process for their preparation and use for coupling to active pharmaceutical ingredients
WO2005014655A2 (en) 2003-08-08 2005-02-17 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland Gmbh Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein
BRPI0412671A (en) 2003-08-08 2006-10-03 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh conjugates of a polymer and a protein linked by an oxime linking group
JP2007501870A (en) * 2003-08-08 2007-02-01 フレゼニウス・カビ・ドイチュラント・ゲゼルシャフト・ミット・ベシュレンクテル・ハフツング Complex of hydroxyalkyl starch and G-CSF
CN1832762B (en) * 2003-08-08 2012-09-05 弗雷泽纽斯卡比德国有限公司 Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and g-csf
EP1660134B1 (en) 2003-08-08 2010-12-29 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and g-csf
DE102004009783A1 (en) 2004-02-28 2005-09-15 Supramol Parenteral Colloids Gmbh Hyperbranched starch fraction, process for its preparation and its conjugates with pharmaceutical agents
AR048035A1 (en) * 2004-03-11 2006-03-22 Fresenius Kabi De Gmbh CONJUGADOS DE ALMIDON DE HIDROXIALQUILO AND A PROTEIN, PREPARED BY REDUCING AMINATION
EP1591476A1 (en) 2004-04-30 2005-11-02 U.S. Greentech, Inc. Turf filler
US7258661B2 (en) * 2004-09-13 2007-08-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Stoma plug
JP2009093397A (en) * 2007-10-09 2009-04-30 Panasonic Corp Touch panel and input device using the same
EP2070950A1 (en) 2007-12-14 2009-06-17 Fresenius Kabi Deutschland GmbH Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7129327B2 (en) * 1986-04-30 2006-10-31 Amylin Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Polypeptide and protein derivatives and process for their preparation

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20100305033A1 (en) 2010-12-02
EA201000798A1 (en) 2010-12-30
IL206223A0 (en) 2010-12-30
EP2070950A8 (en) 2009-08-19
WO2009077154A8 (en) 2009-09-11
WO2009077154A1 (en) 2009-06-25
KR20100099282A (en) 2010-09-10
AU2008337931B2 (en) 2013-10-31
CN101918455A (en) 2010-12-15
EP2070950A1 (en) 2009-06-17
NZ586021A (en) 2012-06-29
AU2008337931A1 (en) 2009-06-25
EA018222B1 (en) 2013-06-28
HK1144780A1 (en) 2011-03-11
ZA201004220B (en) 2011-08-31
JP2011506652A (en) 2011-03-03
EP2231711A1 (en) 2010-09-29
US8404834B2 (en) 2013-03-26
EP2231711B1 (en) 2012-11-07
ES2399003T3 (en) 2013-03-25
BRPI0821133A2 (en) 2015-06-16
CN101918455B (en) 2013-08-28
KR101578955B1 (en) 2015-12-21
JP5486507B2 (en) 2014-05-07
IL206223A (en) 2013-06-27
CA2707811A1 (en) 2009-06-25

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8404834B2 (en) Hydroxyalkyl starch derivatives and process for their preparation
AU2008337930B2 (en) Method for producing a hydroxyalkyl starch derivative with two linkers
AU2005225513B2 (en) Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein, prepared by reductive amination
US8017739B2 (en) Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and a protein
EP1933878B1 (en) Conjugates of hydroxyalkyl starch and an active substance, prepared by chemical ligation via thiazolidine

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: FRESENIUS KABI DEUTSCHLAND GMBH, GERMANY

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:HACKET, FRANK;HEY, THOMAS;HAUSCHILD, FRANZISKA;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20100622 TO 20100701;REEL/FRAME:029830/0888

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION